last minute doc update. Doh!
[Samba.git] / docs / docbook / manpages / smb.conf.5.sgml
blobaf0e65d280497d718ee5777439a0f240d5f8fbdf
1 <!DOCTYPE refentry PUBLIC "-//OASIS//DTD DocBook V4.1//EN">
2 <refentry id="smb.conf">
4 <refmeta>
5 <refentrytitle>smb.conf</refentrytitle>
6 <manvolnum>5</manvolnum>
7 </refmeta>
10 <refnamediv>
11 <refname>smb.conf</refname>
12 <refpurpose>The configuration file for the Samba suite</refpurpose>
13 </refnamediv>
15 <refsect1>
16 <title>SYNOPSIS</title>
18 <para>The <filename>smb.conf</filename> file is a configuration
19 file for the Samba suite. <filename>smb.conf</filename> contains
20 runtime configuration information for the Samba programs. The
21 <filename>smb.conf</filename> file is designed to be configured and
22 administered by the <ulink url="swat.8.html"><command>swat(8)</command>
23 </ulink> program. The complete description of the file format and
24 possible parameters held within are here for reference purposes.</para>
25 </refsect1>
27 <refsect1>
28 <title id="FILEFORMATSECT">FILE FORMAT</title>
30 <para>The file consists of sections and parameters. A section
31 begins with the name of the section in square brackets and continues
32 until the next section begins. Sections contain parameters of the
33 form</para>
35 <para><replaceable>name</replaceable> = <replaceable>value
36 </replaceable></para>
38 <para>The file is line-based - that is, each newline-terminated
39 line represents either a comment, a section name or a parameter.</para>
41 <para>Section and parameter names are not case sensitive.</para>
43 <para>Only the first equals sign in a parameter is significant.
44 Whitespace before or after the first equals sign is discarded.
45 Leading, trailing and internal whitespace in section and parameter
46 names is irrelevant. Leading and trailing whitespace in a parameter
47 value is discarded. Internal whitespace within a parameter value
48 is retained verbatim.</para>
50 <para>Any line beginning with a semicolon (';') or a hash ('#')
51 character is ignored, as are lines containing only whitespace.</para>
53 <para>Any line ending in a '\' is continued
54 on the next line in the customary UNIX fashion.</para>
56 <para>The values following the equals sign in parameters are all
57 either a string (no quotes needed) or a boolean, which may be given
58 as yes/no, 0/1 or true/false. Case is not significant in boolean
59 values, but is preserved in string values. Some items such as
60 create modes are numeric.</para>
61 </refsect1>
63 <refsect1>
64 <title>SECTION DESCRIPTIONS</title>
66 <para>Each section in the configuration file (except for the
67 [global] section) describes a shared resource (known
68 as a "share"). The section name is the name of the
69 shared resource and the parameters within the section define
70 the shares attributes.</para>
72 <para>There are three special sections, [global],
73 [homes] and [printers], which are
74 described under <emphasis>special sections</emphasis>. The
75 following notes apply to ordinary section descriptions.</para>
77 <para>A share consists of a directory to which access is being
78 given plus a description of the access rights which are granted
79 to the user of the service. Some housekeeping options are
80 also specifiable.</para>
82 <para>Sections are either file share services (used by the
83 client as an extension of their native file systems) or
84 printable services (used by the client to access print services
85 on the host running the server).</para>
87 <para>Sections may be designated <emphasis>guest</emphasis> services,
88 in which case no password is required to access them. A specified
89 UNIX <emphasis>guest account</emphasis> is used to define access
90 privileges in this case.</para>
92 <para>Sections other than guest services will require a password
93 to access them. The client provides the username. As older clients
94 only provide passwords and not usernames, you may specify a list
95 of usernames to check against the password using the "user ="
96 option in the share definition. For modern clients such as
97 Windows 95/98/ME/NT/2000, this should not be necessary.</para>
99 <para>Note that the access rights granted by the server are
100 masked by the access rights granted to the specified or guest
101 UNIX user by the host system. The server does not grant more
102 access than the host system grants.</para>
104 <para>The following sample section defines a file space share.
105 The user has write access to the path <filename>/home/bar</filename>.
106 The share is accessed via the share name "foo":</para>
108 <screen>
109 <computeroutput>
110 [foo]
111 path = /home/bar
112 writeable = true
113 </computeroutput>
114 </screen>
116 <para>The following sample section defines a printable share.
117 The share is readonly, but printable. That is, the only write
118 access permitted is via calls to open, write to and close a
119 spool file. The <emphasis>guest ok</emphasis> parameter means
120 access will be permitted as the default guest user (specified
121 elsewhere):</para>
123 <screen>
124 <computeroutput>
125 [aprinter]
126 path = /usr/spool/public
127 writeable = false
128 printable = true
129 guest ok = true
130 </computeroutput>
131 </screen>
132 </refsect1>
134 <refsect1>
135 <title>SPECIAL SECTIONS</title>
137 <refsect2>
138 <title>The [global] section</title>
140 <para>parameters in this section apply to the server
141 as a whole, or are defaults for sections which do not
142 specifically define certain items. See the notes
143 under PARAMETERS for more information.</para>
144 </refsect2>
146 <refsect2>
147 <title id="HOMESECT">The [homes] section</title>
149 <para>If a section called homes is included in the
150 configuration file, services connecting clients to their
151 home directories can be created on the fly by the server.</para>
153 <para>When the connection request is made, the existing
154 sections are scanned. If a match is found, it is used. If no
155 match is found, the requested section name is treated as a
156 user name and looked up in the local password file. If the
157 name exists and the correct password has been given, a share is
158 created by cloning the [homes] section.</para>
160 <para>Some modifications are then made to the newly
161 created share:</para>
163 <itemizedlist>
164 <listitem><para>The share name is changed from homes to
165 the located username.</para></listitem>
167 <listitem><para>If no path was given, the path is set to
168 the user's home directory.</para></listitem>
169 </itemizedlist>
171 <para>If you decide to use a <emphasis>path =</emphasis> line
172 in your [homes] section then you may find it useful
173 to use the %S macro. For example :</para>
175 <para><userinput>path = /data/pchome/%S</userinput></para>
177 <para>would be useful if you have different home directories
178 for your PCs than for UNIX access.</para>
180 <para>This is a fast and simple way to give a large number
181 of clients access to their home directories with a minimum
182 of fuss.</para>
184 <para>A similar process occurs if the requested section
185 name is "homes", except that the share name is not
186 changed to that of the requesting user. This method of using
187 the [homes] section works well if different users share
188 a client PC.</para>
190 <para>The [homes] section can specify all the parameters
191 a normal service section can specify, though some make more sense
192 than others. The following is a typical and suitable [homes]
193 section:</para>
195 <screen>
196 <computeroutput>
197 [homes]
198 writeable = yes
199 </computeroutput>
200 </screen>
202 <para>An important point is that if guest access is specified
203 in the [homes] section, all home directories will be
204 visible to all clients <emphasis>without a password</emphasis>.
205 In the very unlikely event that this is actually desirable, it
206 would be wise to also specify <emphasis>read only
207 access</emphasis>.</para>
209 <para>Note that the <emphasis>browseable</emphasis> flag for
210 auto home directories will be inherited from the global browseable
211 flag, not the [homes] browseable flag. This is useful as
212 it means setting <emphasis>browseable = no</emphasis> in
213 the [homes] section will hide the [homes] share but make
214 any auto home directories visible.</para>
215 </refsect2>
217 <refsect2>
218 <title id="PRINTERSSECT">The [printers] section</title>
220 <para>This section works like [homes],
221 but for printers.</para>
223 <para>If a [printers] section occurs in the
224 configuration file, users are able to connect to any printer
225 specified in the local host's printcap file.</para>
227 <para>When a connection request is made, the existing sections
228 are scanned. If a match is found, it is used. If no match is found,
229 but a [homes] section exists, it is used as described
230 above. Otherwise, the requested section name is treated as a
231 printer name and the appropriate printcap file is scanned to see
232 if the requested section name is a valid printer share name. If
233 a match is found, a new printer share is created by cloning
234 the [printers] section.</para>
236 <para>A few modifications are then made to the newly created
237 share:</para>
239 <itemizedlist>
240 <listitem><para>The share name is set to the located printer
241 name</para></listitem>
243 <listitem><para>If no printer name was given, the printer name
244 is set to the located printer name</para></listitem>
246 <listitem><para>If the share does not permit guest access and
247 no username was given, the username is set to the located
248 printer name.</para></listitem>
249 </itemizedlist>
251 <para>Note that the [printers] service MUST be
252 printable - if you specify otherwise, the server will refuse
253 to load the configuration file.</para>
255 <para>Typically the path specified would be that of a
256 world-writeable spool directory with the sticky bit set on
257 it. A typical [printers] entry would look like
258 this:</para>
260 <screen><computeroutput>
261 [printers]
262 path = /usr/spool/public
263 guest ok = yes
264 printable = yes
265 </computeroutput></screen>
267 <para>All aliases given for a printer in the printcap file
268 are legitimate printer names as far as the server is concerned.
269 If your printing subsystem doesn't work like that, you will have
270 to set up a pseudo-printcap. This is a file consisting of one or
271 more lines like this:</para>
273 <screen>
274 <computeroutput>
275 alias|alias|alias|alias...
276 </computeroutput>
277 </screen>
279 <para>Each alias should be an acceptable printer name for
280 your printing subsystem. In the [global] section, specify
281 the new file as your printcap. The server will then only recognize
282 names found in your pseudo-printcap, which of course can contain
283 whatever aliases you like. The same technique could be used
284 simply to limit access to a subset of your local printers.</para>
286 <para>An alias, by the way, is defined as any component of the
287 first entry of a printcap record. Records are separated by newlines,
288 components (if there are more than one) are separated by vertical
289 bar symbols ('|').</para>
291 <para>NOTE: On SYSV systems which use lpstat to determine what
292 printers are defined on the system you may be able to use
293 "printcap name = lpstat" to automatically obtain a list
294 of printers. See the "printcap name" option
295 for more details.</para>
296 </refsect2>
297 </refsect1>
299 <refsect1>
300 <title>PARAMETERS</title>
302 <para>parameters define the specific attributes of sections.</para>
304 <para>Some parameters are specific to the [global] section
305 (e.g., <emphasis>security</emphasis>). Some parameters are usable
306 in all sections (e.g., <emphasis>create mode</emphasis>). All others
307 are permissible only in normal sections. For the purposes of the
308 following descriptions the [homes] and [printers]
309 sections will be considered normal. The letter <emphasis>G</emphasis>
310 in parentheses indicates that a parameter is specific to the
311 [global] section. The letter <emphasis>S</emphasis>
312 indicates that a parameter can be specified in a service specific
313 section. Note that all <emphasis>S</emphasis> parameters can also be specified in
314 the [global] section - in which case they will define
315 the default behavior for all services.</para>
317 <para>parameters are arranged here in alphabetical order - this may
318 not create best bedfellows, but at least you can find them! Where
319 there are synonyms, the preferred synonym is described, others refer
320 to the preferred synonym.</para>
321 </refsect1>
323 <refsect1>
324 <title>VARIABLE SUBSTITUTIONS</title>
326 <para>Many of the strings that are settable in the config file
327 can take substitutions. For example the option "path =
328 /tmp/%u" would be interpreted as "path =
329 /tmp/john" if the user connected with the username john.</para>
331 <para>These substitutions are mostly noted in the descriptions below,
332 but there are some general substitutions which apply whenever they
333 might be relevant. These are:</para>
335 <variablelist>
336 <varlistentry>
337 <term>%S</term>
338 <listitem><para>the name of the current service, if any.</para>
339 </listitem>
340 </varlistentry>
342 <varlistentry>
343 <term>%P</term>
344 <listitem><para>the root directory of the current service,
345 if any.</para></listitem>
346 </varlistentry>
348 <varlistentry>
349 <term>%u</term>
350 <listitem><para>user name of the current service, if any.</para>
351 </listitem>
352 </varlistentry>
354 <varlistentry>
355 <term>%g</term>
356 <listitem><para>primary group name of %u.</para></listitem>
357 </varlistentry>
359 <varlistentry>
360 <term>%U</term>
361 <listitem><para>session user name (the user name that the client
362 wanted, not necessarily the same as the one they got).</para></listitem>
363 </varlistentry>
365 <varlistentry>
366 <term>%G</term>
367 <listitem><para>primary group name of %U.</para></listitem>
368 </varlistentry>
370 <varlistentry>
371 <term>%H</term>
372 <listitem><para>the home directory of the user given
373 by %u.</para></listitem>
374 </varlistentry>
376 <varlistentry>
377 <term>%v</term>
378 <listitem><para>the Samba version.</para></listitem>
379 </varlistentry>
381 <varlistentry>
382 <term>%h</term>
383 <listitem><para>the Internet hostname that Samba is running
384 on.</para></listitem>
385 </varlistentry>
387 <varlistentry>
388 <term>%m</term>
389 <listitem><para>the NetBIOS name of the client machine
390 (very useful).</para></listitem>
391 </varlistentry>
393 <varlistentry>
394 <term>%L</term>
395 <listitem><para>the NetBIOS name of the server. This allows you
396 to change your config based on what the client calls you. Your
397 server can have a "dual personality".</para></listitem>
398 </varlistentry>
400 <varlistentry>
401 <term>%M</term>
402 <listitem><para>the Internet name of the client machine.
403 </para></listitem>
404 </varlistentry>
406 <varlistentry>
407 <term>%N</term>
408 <listitem><para>the name of your NIS home directory server.
409 This is obtained from your NIS auto.map entry. If you have
410 not compiled Samba with the <emphasis>--with-automount</emphasis>
411 option then this value will be the same as %L.</para>
412 </listitem>
413 </varlistentry>
415 <varlistentry>
416 <term>%p</term>
417 <listitem><para>the path of the service's home directory,
418 obtained from your NIS auto.map entry. The NIS auto.map entry
419 is split up as "%N:%p".</para></listitem>
420 </varlistentry>
422 <varlistentry>
423 <term>%R</term>
424 <listitem><para>the selected protocol level after
425 protocol negotiation. It can be one of CORE, COREPLUS,
426 LANMAN1, LANMAN2 or NT1.</para></listitem>
427 </varlistentry>
429 <varlistentry>
430 <term>%d</term>
431 <listitem><para>The process id of the current server
432 process.</para></listitem>
433 </varlistentry>
435 <varlistentry>
436 <term>%a</term>
437 <listitem><para>the architecture of the remote
438 machine. Only some are recognized, and those may not be
439 100% reliable. It currently recognizes Samba, WfWg, Win95,
440 WinNT and Win2k. Anything else will be known as
441 "UNKNOWN". If it gets it wrong then sending a level
442 3 log to <ulink url="mailto:samba@samba.org">samba@samba.org
443 </ulink> should allow it to be fixed.</para></listitem>
444 </varlistentry>
446 <varlistentry>
447 <term>%I</term>
448 <listitem><para>The IP address of the client machine.</para>
449 </listitem>
450 </varlistentry>
452 <varlistentry>
453 <term>%T</term>
454 <listitem><para>the current date and time.</para></listitem>
455 </varlistentry>
457 <varlistentry>
458 <term>%$(<replaceable>envvar</replaceable>)</term>
459 <listitem><para>The value of the environment variable
460 <replaceable>envar</replaceable>.</para></listitem>
461 </varlistentry>
462 </variablelist>
464 <para>There are some quite creative things that can be done
465 with these substitutions and other smb.conf options.</para
466 </refsect1>
468 <refsect1>
469 <title id="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">NAME MANGLING</title>
471 <para>Samba supports "name mangling" so that DOS and
472 Windows clients can use files that don't conform to the 8.3 format.
473 It can also be set to adjust the case of 8.3 format filenames.</para>
475 <para>There are several options that control the way mangling is
476 performed, and they are grouped here rather than listed separately.
477 For the defaults look at the output of the testparm program. </para>
479 <para>All of these options can be set separately for each service
480 (or globally, of course). </para>
482 <para>The options are: </para>
484 <variablelist>
486 <varlistentry>
487 <term>mangle case = yes/no</term>
488 <listitem><para> controls if names that have characters that
489 aren't of the "default" case are mangled. For example,
490 if this is yes then a name like "Mail" would be mangled.
491 Default <emphasis>no</emphasis>.</para></listitem>
492 </varlistentry>
494 <varlistentry>
495 <term>case sensitive = yes/no</term>
496 <listitem><para>controls whether filenames are case sensitive. If
497 they aren't then Samba must do a filename search and match on passed
498 names. Default <emphasis>no</emphasis>.</para></listitem>
499 </varlistentry>
501 <varlistentry>
502 <term>default case = upper/lower</term>
503 <listitem><para>controls what the default case is for new
504 filenames. Default <emphasis>lower</emphasis>.</para></listitem>
505 </varlistentry>
507 <varlistentry>
508 <term>preserve case = yes/no</term>
509 <listitem><para>controls if new files are created with the
510 case that the client passes, or if they are forced to be the
511 "default" case. Default <emphasis>yes</emphasis>.
512 </para></listitem>
513 </varlistentry>
515 <varlistentry>
516 <term>short preserve case = yes/no</term>
517 <listitem><para>controls if new files which conform to 8.3 syntax,
518 that is all in upper case and of suitable length, are created
519 upper case, or if they are forced to be the "default"
520 case. This option can be use with "preserve case = yes"
521 to permit long filenames to retain their case, while short names
522 are lowercased. Default <emphasis>yes</emphasis>.</para></listitem>
523 </varlistentry>
524 </variablelist>
526 <para>By default, Samba 2.2 has the same semantics as a Windows
527 NT server, in that it is case insensitive but case preserving.</para>
529 </refsect1>
531 <refsect1>
532 <title id="VALIDATIONSECT">NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</title>
534 <para>There are a number of ways in which a user can connect
535 to a service. The server uses the following steps in determining
536 if it will allow a connection to a specified service. If all the
537 steps fail, then the connection request is rejected. However, if one of the
538 steps succeeds, then the following steps are not checked.</para>
540 <para>If the service is marked "guest only = yes" and the
541 server is running with share-level security ("security = share")
542 then steps 1 to 5 are skipped.</para>
545 <orderedlist numeration="Arabic">
546 <listitem><para>If the client has passed a username/password
547 pair and that username/password pair is validated by the UNIX
548 system's password programs then the connection is made as that
549 username. Note that this includes the
550 \\server\service%<replaceable>username</replaceable> method of passing
551 a username.</para></listitem>
553 <listitem><para>If the client has previously registered a username
554 with the system and now supplies a correct password for that
555 username then the connection is allowed.</para></listitem>
557 <listitem><para>The client's NetBIOS name and any previously
558 used user names are checked against the supplied password, if
559 they match then the connection is allowed as the corresponding
560 user.</para></listitem>
562 <listitem><para>If the client has previously validated a
563 username/password pair with the server and the client has passed
564 the validation token then that username is used. </para></listitem>
566 <listitem><para>If a "user = " field is given in the
567 <filename>smb.conf</filename> file for the service and the client
568 has supplied a password, and that password matches (according to
569 the UNIX system's password checking) with one of the usernames
570 from the "user =" field then the connection is made as
571 the username in the "user =" line. If one
572 of the username in the "user =" list begins with a
573 '@' then that name expands to a list of names in
574 the group of the same name.</para></listitem>
576 <listitem><para>If the service is a guest service then a
577 connection is made as the username given in the "guest
578 account =" for the service, irrespective of the
579 supplied password.</para></listitem>
580 </orderedlist>
582 </refsect1>
584 <refsect1>
585 <title>COMPLETE LIST OF GLOBAL PARAMETERS</title>
587 <para>Here is a list of all global parameters. See the section of
588 each parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.</para>
590 <itemizedlist>
591 <listitem><para><link linkend="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>add printer command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
592 <listitem><para><link linkend="ADDSHARECOMMAND"><parameter>add share command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
593 <listitem><para><link linkend="ADDUSERSCRIPT"><parameter>add user script</parameter></link></para></listitem>
594 <listitem><para><link linkend="ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS"><parameter>allow trusted domains</parameter></link></para></listitem>
595 <listitem><para><link linkend="ANNOUNCEAS"><parameter>announce as</parameter></link></para></listitem>
596 <listitem><para><link linkend="ANNOUNCEVERSION"><parameter>announce version</parameter></link></para></listitem>
597 <listitem><para><link linkend="AUTOSERVICES"><parameter>auto services</parameter></link></para></listitem>
598 <listitem><para><link linkend="BINDINTERFACESONLY"><parameter>bind interfaces only</parameter></link></para></listitem>
599 <listitem><para><link linkend="BROWSELIST"><parameter>browse list</parameter></link></para></listitem>
600 <listitem><para><link linkend="CHANGENOTIFYTIMEOUT"><parameter>change notify timeout</parameter></link></para></listitem>
601 <listitem><para><link linkend="CHANGESHARECOMMAND"><parameter>change share command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
602 <listitem><para><link linkend="CHARACTERSET"><parameter>character set</parameter></link></para></listitem>
603 <listitem><para><link linkend="CLIENTCODEPAGE"><parameter>client code page</parameter></link></para></listitem>
604 <listitem><para><link linkend="CODEPAGEDIRECTORY"><parameter>code page directory</parameter></link></para></listitem>
605 <listitem><para><link linkend="CODINGSYSTEM"><parameter>coding system</parameter></link></para></listitem>
606 <listitem><para><link linkend="CONFIGFILE"><parameter>config file</parameter></link></para></listitem>
607 <listitem><para><link linkend="DEADTIME"><parameter>deadtime</parameter></link></para></listitem>
608 <listitem><para><link linkend="DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP"><parameter>debug hires timestamp</parameter></link></para></listitem>
609 <listitem><para><link linkend="DEBUGPID"><parameter>debug pid</parameter></link></para></listitem>
610 <listitem><para><link linkend="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><parameter>debug timestamp</parameter></link></para></listitem>
611 <listitem><para><link linkend="DEBUGUID"><parameter>debug uid</parameter></link></para></listitem>
612 <listitem><para><link linkend="DEBUGLEVEL"><parameter>debuglevel</parameter></link></para></listitem>
613 <listitem><para><link linkend="DEFAULT"><parameter>default</parameter></link></para></listitem>
614 <listitem><para><link linkend="DEFAULTSERVICE"><parameter>default service</parameter></link></para></listitem>
615 <listitem><para><link linkend="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>delete printer command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
616 <listitem><para><link linkend="DELETESHARECOMMAND"><parameter>delete share command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
617 <listitem><para><link linkend="DELETEUSERSCRIPT"><parameter>delete user script</parameter></link></para></listitem>
618 <listitem><para><link linkend="DFREECOMMAND"><parameter>dfree command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
619 <listitem><para><link linkend="DISABLESPOOLSS"><parameter>disable spoolss</parameter></link></para></listitem>
620 <listitem><para><link linkend="DNSPROXY"><parameter>dns proxy</parameter></link></para></listitem>
621 <listitem><para><link linkend="DOMAINADMINGROUP"><parameter>domain admin group</parameter></link></para></listitem>
622 <listitem><para><link linkend="DOMAINGUESTGROUP"><parameter>domain guest group</parameter></link></para></listitem>
623 <listitem><para><link linkend="DOMAINLOGONS"><parameter>domain logons</parameter></link></para></listitem>
624 <listitem><para><link linkend="DOMAINMASTER"><parameter>domain master</parameter></link></para></listitem>
625 <listitem><para><link linkend="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"><parameter>encrypt passwords</parameter></link></para></listitem>
626 <listitem><para><link linkend="ENHANCEDBROWSING"><parameter>enhanced browsing</parameter></link></para></listitem>
627 <listitem><para><link linkend="ENUMPORTSCOMMAND"><parameter>enumports command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
628 <listitem><para><link linkend="GETWDCACHE"><parameter>getwd cache</parameter></link></para></listitem>
629 <listitem><para><link linkend="HIDELOCALUSERS"><parameter>hide local users</parameter></link></para></listitem>
630 <listitem><para><link linkend="HIDEUNREADABLE"><parameter>hide unreadable</parameter></link></para></listitem>
631 <listitem><para><link linkend="HOMEDIRMAP"><parameter>homedir map</parameter></link></para></listitem>
632 <listitem><para><link linkend="HOSTMSDFS"><parameter>host msdfs</parameter></link></para></listitem>
633 <listitem><para><link linkend="HOSTSEQUIV"><parameter>hosts equiv</parameter></link></para></listitem>
634 <listitem><para><link linkend="INTERFACES"><parameter>interfaces</parameter></link></para></listitem>
635 <listitem><para><link linkend="KEEPALIVE"><parameter>keepalive</parameter></link></para></listitem>
636 <listitem><para><link linkend="KERNELOPLOCKS"><parameter>kernel oplocks</parameter></link></para></listitem>
637 <listitem><para><link linkend="LANMANAUTH"><parameter>lanman auth</parameter></link></para></listitem>
638 <listitem><para><link linkend="LARGEREADWRITE"><parameter>large readwrite</parameter></link></para></listitem>
640 <listitem><para><link linkend="LDAPADMINDN"><parameter>ldap admin dn</parameter></link></para></listitem>
641 <listitem><para><link linkend="LDAPFILTER"><parameter>ldap filter</parameter></link></para></listitem>
642 <listitem><para><link linkend="LDAPPORT"><parameter>ldap port</parameter></link></para></listitem>
643 <listitem><para><link linkend="LDAPSERVER"><parameter>ldap server</parameter></link></para></listitem>
644 <listitem><para><link linkend="LDAPSSL"><parameter>ldap ssl</parameter></link></para></listitem>
645 <listitem><para><link linkend="LDAPSUFFIX"><parameter>ldap suffix</parameter></link></para></listitem>
647 <listitem><para><link linkend="LMANNOUNCE"><parameter>lm announce</parameter></link></para></listitem>
648 <listitem><para><link linkend="LMINTERVAL"><parameter>lm interval</parameter></link></para></listitem>
649 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOADPRINTERS"><parameter>load printers</parameter></link></para></listitem>
650 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOCALMASTER"><parameter>local master</parameter></link></para></listitem>
651 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOCKDIR"><parameter>lock dir</parameter></link></para></listitem>
652 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOCKDIRECTORY"><parameter>lock directory</parameter></link></para></listitem>
653 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOCKSPINCOUNT"><parameter>lock spin count</parameter></link></para></listitem>
654 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOCKSPINTIME"><parameter>lock spin time</parameter></link></para></listitem>
655 <listitem><para><link linkend="PIDDIRECTORY"><parameter>pid directory</parameter></link></para></listitem>
656 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOGFILE"><parameter>log file</parameter></link></para></listitem>
657 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOGLEVEL"><parameter>log level</parameter></link></para></listitem>
658 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOGONDRIVE"><parameter>logon drive</parameter></link></para></listitem>
659 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOGONHOME"><parameter>logon home</parameter></link></para></listitem>
660 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOGONPATH"><parameter>logon path</parameter></link></para></listitem>
661 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOGONSCRIPT"><parameter>logon script</parameter></link></para></listitem>
662 <listitem><para><link linkend="LPQCACHETIME"><parameter>lpq cache time</parameter></link></para></listitem>
663 <listitem><para><link linkend="MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT"><parameter>machine password timeout</parameter></link></para></listitem>
664 <listitem><para><link linkend="MANGLEDSTACK"><parameter>mangled stack</parameter></link></para></listitem>
665 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAPTOGUEST"><parameter>map to guest</parameter></link></para></listitem>
666 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXDISKSIZE"><parameter>max disk size</parameter></link></para></listitem>
667 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXLOGSIZE"><parameter>max log size</parameter></link></para></listitem>
668 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXMUX"><parameter>max mux</parameter></link></para></listitem>
669 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXOPENFILES"><parameter>max open files</parameter></link></para></listitem>
670 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXPROTOCOL"><parameter>max protocol</parameter></link></para></listitem>
671 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXSMBDPROCESSES"><parameter>max smbd processes</parameter></link></para></listitem>
672 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXTTL"><parameter>max ttl</parameter></link></para></listitem>
673 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXWINSTTL"><parameter>max wins ttl</parameter></link></para></listitem>
674 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXXMIT"><parameter>max xmit</parameter></link></para></listitem>
675 <listitem><para><link linkend="MESSAGECOMMAND"><parameter>message command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
676 <listitem><para><link linkend="MINPASSWDLENGTH"><parameter>min passwd length</parameter></link></para></listitem>
677 <listitem><para><link linkend="MINPASSWORDLENGTH"><parameter>min password length</parameter></link></para></listitem>
678 <listitem><para><link linkend="MINPROTOCOL"><parameter>min protocol</parameter></link></para></listitem>
679 <listitem><para><link linkend="MINWINSTTL"><parameter>min wins ttl</parameter></link></para></listitem>
680 <listitem><para><link linkend="NAMERESOLVEORDER"><parameter>name resolve order</parameter></link></para></listitem>
681 <listitem><para><link linkend="NETBIOSALIASES"><parameter>netbios aliases</parameter></link></para></listitem>
682 <listitem><para><link linkend="NETBIOSNAME"><parameter>netbios name</parameter></link></para></listitem>
683 <listitem><para><link linkend="NETBIOSSCOPE"><parameter>netbios scope</parameter></link></para></listitem>
684 <listitem><para><link linkend="NISHOMEDIR"><parameter>nis homedir</parameter></link></para></listitem>
685 <listitem><para><link linkend="NTPIPESUPPORT"><parameter>nt pipe support</parameter></link></para></listitem>
686 <listitem><para><link linkend="NTSMBSUPPORT"><parameter>nt smb support</parameter></link></para></listitem>
687 <listitem><para><link linkend="NTSTATUSSUPPORT"><parameter>nt status support</parameter></link></para></listitem>
688 <listitem><para><link linkend="NULLPASSWORDS"><parameter>null passwords</parameter></link></para></listitem>
689 <listitem><para><link linkend="OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS"><parameter>obey pam restrictions</parameter></link></para></listitem>
690 <listitem><para><link linkend="OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME"><parameter>oplock break wait time</parameter></link></para></listitem>
691 <listitem><para><link linkend="OSLEVEL"><parameter>os level</parameter></link></para></listitem>
692 <listitem><para><link linkend="OS2DRIVERMAP"><parameter>os2 driver map</parameter></link></para></listitem>
693 <listitem><para><link linkend="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"><parameter>pam password change</parameter></link></para></listitem>
694 <listitem><para><link linkend="PANICACTION"><parameter>panic action</parameter></link></para></listitem>
695 <listitem><para><link linkend="PASSWDCHAT"><parameter>passwd chat</parameter></link></para></listitem>
696 <listitem><para><link linkend="PASSWDCHATDEBUG"><parameter>passwd chat debug</parameter></link></para></listitem>
697 <listitem><para><link linkend="PASSWDPROGRAM"><parameter>passwd program</parameter></link></para></listitem>
698 <listitem><para><link linkend="PASSWORDLEVEL"><parameter>password level</parameter></link></para></listitem>
699 <listitem><para><link linkend="PASSWORDSERVER"><parameter>password server</parameter></link></para></listitem>
700 <listitem><para><link linkend="PREFEREDMASTER"><parameter>prefered master</parameter></link></para></listitem>
701 <listitem><para><link linkend="PREFERREDMASTER"><parameter>preferred master</parameter></link></para></listitem>
702 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRELOAD"><parameter>preload</parameter></link></para></listitem>
703 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTCAP"><parameter>printcap</parameter></link></para></listitem>
704 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTCAPNAME"><parameter>printcap name</parameter></link></para></listitem>
705 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTERDRIVERFILE"><parameter>printer driver file</parameter></link></para></listitem>
706 <listitem><para><link linkend="PROTOCOL"><parameter>protocol</parameter></link></para></listitem>
707 <listitem><para><link linkend="READBMPX"><parameter>read bmpx</parameter></link></para></listitem>
708 <listitem><para><link linkend="READRAW"><parameter>read raw</parameter></link></para></listitem>
709 <listitem><para><link linkend="READSIZE"><parameter>read size</parameter></link></para></listitem>
710 <listitem><para><link linkend="REMOTEANNOUNCE"><parameter>remote announce</parameter></link></para></listitem>
711 <listitem><para><link linkend="REMOTEBROWSESYNC"><parameter>remote browse sync</parameter></link></para></listitem>
712 <listitem><para><link linkend="RESTRICTANONYMOUS"><parameter>restrict anonymous</parameter></link></para></listitem>
713 <listitem><para><link linkend="ROOT"><parameter>root</parameter></link></para></listitem>
714 <listitem><para><link linkend="ROOTDIR"><parameter>root dir</parameter></link></para></listitem>
715 <listitem><para><link linkend="ROOTDIRECTORY"><parameter>root directory</parameter></link></para></listitem>
716 <listitem><para><link linkend="SECURITY"><parameter>security</parameter></link></para></listitem>
717 <listitem><para><link linkend="SERVERSTRING"><parameter>server string</parameter></link></para></listitem>
718 <listitem><para><link linkend="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"><parameter>show add printer wizard</parameter></link></para></listitem>
719 <listitem><para><link linkend="SMBPASSWDFILE"><parameter>smb passwd file</parameter></link></para></listitem>
720 <listitem><para><link linkend="SOCKETADDRESS"><parameter>socket address</parameter></link></para></listitem>
721 <listitem><para><link linkend="SOCKETOPTIONS"><parameter>socket options</parameter></link></para></listitem>
722 <listitem><para><link linkend="SOURCEENVIRONMENT"><parameter>source environment</parameter></link></para></listitem>
724 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSL"><parameter>ssl</parameter></link></para></listitem>
725 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLCACERTDIR"><parameter>ssl CA certDir</parameter></link></para></listitem>
726 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLCACERTFILE"><parameter>ssl CA certFile</parameter></link></para></listitem>
727 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLCIPHERS"><parameter>ssl ciphers</parameter></link></para></listitem>
728 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLCLIENTCERT"><parameter>ssl client cert</parameter></link></para></listitem>
729 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLCLIENTKEY"><parameter>ssl client key</parameter></link></para></listitem>
730 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLCOMPATIBILITY"><parameter>ssl compatibility</parameter></link></para></listitem>
731 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLEGDSOCKET"><parameter>ssl egd socket</parameter></link></para></listitem>
732 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLENTROPYBYTES"><parameter>ssl entropy bytes</parameter></link></para></listitem>
733 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLENTROPYFILE"><parameter>ssl entropy file</parameter></link></para></listitem>
734 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLHOSTS"><parameter>ssl hosts</parameter></link></para></listitem>
735 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLHOSTSRESIGN"><parameter>ssl hosts resign</parameter></link></para></listitem>
736 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLREQUIRECLIENTCERT"><parameter>ssl require clientcert</parameter></link></para></listitem>
737 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLREQUIRESERVERCERT"><parameter>ssl require servercert</parameter></link></para></listitem>
738 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLSERVERCERT"><parameter>ssl server cert</parameter></link></para></listitem>
739 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLSERVERKEY"><parameter>ssl server key</parameter></link></para></listitem>
740 <listitem><para><link linkend="SSLVERSION"><parameter>ssl version</parameter></link></para></listitem>
742 <listitem><para><link linkend="STATCACHE"><parameter>stat cache</parameter></link></para></listitem>
743 <listitem><para><link linkend="STATCACHESIZE"><parameter>stat cache size</parameter></link></para></listitem>
744 <listitem><para><link linkend="STRIPDOT"><parameter>strip dot</parameter></link></para></listitem>
745 <listitem><para><link linkend="SYSLOG"><parameter>syslog</parameter></link></para></listitem>
746 <listitem><para><link linkend="SYSLOGONLY"><parameter>syslog only</parameter></link></para></listitem>
747 <listitem><para><link linkend="TEMPLATEHOMEDIR"><parameter>template homedir</parameter></link></para></listitem>
748 <listitem><para><link linkend="TEMPLATESHELL"><parameter>template shell</parameter></link></para></listitem>
749 <listitem><para><link linkend="TIMEOFFSET"><parameter>time offset</parameter></link></para></listitem>
750 <listitem><para><link linkend="TIMESERVER"><parameter>time server</parameter></link></para></listitem>
751 <listitem><para><link linkend="TIMESTAMPLOGS"><parameter>timestamp logs</parameter></link></para></listitem>
752 <listitem><para><link linkend="TOTALPRINTJOBS"><parameter>total print jobs</parameter></link></para></listitem>
753 <listitem><para><link linkend="UNIXEXTENSIONS"><parameter>unix extensions</parameter></link></para></listitem>
754 <listitem><para><link linkend="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"><parameter>unix password sync</parameter></link></para></listitem>
755 <listitem><para><link linkend="UPDATEENCRYPTED"><parameter>update encrypted</parameter></link></para></listitem>
756 <listitem><para><link linkend="USEMMAP"><parameter>use mmap</parameter></link></para></listitem>
757 <listitem><para><link linkend="USERHOSTS"><parameter>use rhosts</parameter></link></para></listitem>
758 <listitem><para><link linkend="USERNAMELEVEL"><parameter>username level</parameter></link></para></listitem>
759 <listitem><para><link linkend="USERNAMEMAP"><parameter>username map</parameter></link></para></listitem>
760 <listitem><para><link linkend="UTMP"><parameter>utmp</parameter></link></para></listitem>
761 <listitem><para><link linkend="UTMPDIRECTORY"><parameter>utmp directory</parameter></link></para></listitem>
762 <listitem><para><link linkend="VALIDCHARS"><parameter>valid chars</parameter></link></para></listitem>
763 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINBINDCACHETIME"><parameter>winbind cache time</parameter></link></para></listitem>
764 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINBINDENUMUSERS"><parameter>winbind enum users</parameter></link></para></listitem>
765 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINBINDENUMGROUPS"><parameter>winbind enum groups</parameter></link></para></listitem>
766 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINBINDGID"><parameter>winbind gid</parameter></link></para></listitem>
767 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINBINDSEPARATOR"><parameter>winbind separator</parameter></link></para></listitem>
768 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINBINDUID"><parameter>winbind uid</parameter></link></para></listitem>
769 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN"><parameter>winbind use default domain</parameter></link></para></listitem>
770 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINSHOOK"><parameter>wins hook</parameter></link></para></listitem>
771 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINSPROXY"><parameter>wins proxy</parameter></link></para></listitem>
772 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINSSERVER"><parameter>wins server</parameter></link></para></listitem>
773 <listitem><para><link linkend="WINSSUPPORT"><parameter>wins support</parameter></link></para></listitem>
774 <listitem><para><link linkend="WORKGROUP"><parameter>workgroup</parameter></link></para></listitem>
775 <listitem><para><link linkend="WRITERAW"><parameter>write raw</parameter></link></para></listitem>
776 </itemizedlist>
778 </refsect1>
780 <refsect1>
781 <title>COMPLETE LIST OF SERVICE PARAMETERS</title>
783 <para>Here is a list of all service parameters. See the section on
784 each parameter for details. Note that some are synonyms.</para>
786 <itemizedlist>
787 <listitem><para><link linkend="ADMINUSERS"><parameter>admin users</parameter></link></para></listitem>
788 <listitem><para><link linkend="ALLOWHOSTS"><parameter>allow hosts</parameter></link></para></listitem>
789 <listitem><para><link linkend="AVAILABLE"><parameter>available</parameter></link></para></listitem>
790 <listitem><para><link linkend="BLOCKINGLOCKS"><parameter>blocking locks</parameter></link></para></listitem>
791 <listitem><para><link linkend="BROWSABLE"><parameter>browsable</parameter></link></para></listitem>
792 <listitem><para><link linkend="BROWSEABLE"><parameter>browseable</parameter></link></para></listitem>
793 <listitem><para><link linkend="CASESENSITIVE"><parameter>case sensitive</parameter></link></para></listitem>
794 <listitem><para><link linkend="CASESIGNAMES"><parameter>casesignames</parameter></link></para></listitem>
795 <listitem><para><link linkend="COMMENT"><parameter>comment</parameter></link></para></listitem>
796 <listitem><para><link linkend="COPY"><parameter>copy</parameter></link></para></listitem>
797 <listitem><para><link linkend="CREATEMASK"><parameter>create mask</parameter></link></para></listitem>
798 <listitem><para><link linkend="CREATEMODE"><parameter>create mode</parameter></link></para></listitem>
799 <listitem><para><link linkend="CSCPOLICY"><parameter>csc policy</parameter></link></para></listitem>
801 <listitem><para><link linkend="DEFAULTCASE"><parameter>default case</parameter></link></para></listitem>
802 <listitem><para><link linkend="DEFAULTDEVMODE"><parameter>default devmode</parameter></link></para></listitem>
803 <listitem><para><link linkend="DELETEREADONLY"><parameter>delete readonly</parameter></link></para></listitem>
804 <listitem><para><link linkend="DELETEVETOFILES"><parameter>delete veto files</parameter></link></para></listitem>
805 <listitem><para><link linkend="DENYHOSTS"><parameter>deny hosts</parameter></link></para></listitem>
806 <listitem><para><link linkend="DIRECTORY"><parameter>directory</parameter></link></para></listitem>
807 <listitem><para><link linkend="DIRECTORYMASK"><parameter>directory mask</parameter></link></para></listitem>
808 <listitem><para><link linkend="DIRECTORYMODE"><parameter>directory mode</parameter></link></para></listitem>
809 <listitem><para><link linkend="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"><parameter>directory security mask</parameter></link></para></listitem>
810 <listitem><para><link linkend="DONTDESCEND"><parameter>dont descend</parameter></link></para></listitem>
811 <listitem><para><link linkend="DOSFILEMODE"><parameter>dos filemode</parameter></link></para></listitem>
812 <listitem><para><link linkend="DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION"><parameter>dos filetime resolution</parameter></link></para></listitem>
813 <listitem><para><link linkend="DOSFILETIMES"><parameter>dos filetimes</parameter></link></para></listitem>
814 <listitem><para><link linkend="EXEC"><parameter>exec</parameter></link></para></listitem>
815 <listitem><para><link linkend="FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES"><parameter>fake directory create times</parameter></link></para></listitem>
816 <listitem><para><link linkend="FAKEOPLOCKS"><parameter>fake oplocks</parameter></link></para></listitem>
817 <listitem><para><link linkend="FOLLOWSYMLINKS"><parameter>follow symlinks</parameter></link></para></listitem>
818 <listitem><para><link linkend="FORCECREATEMODE"><parameter>force create mode</parameter></link></para></listitem>
819 <listitem><para><link linkend="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"><parameter>force directory mode</parameter></link></para></listitem>
820 <listitem><para><link linkend="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"><parameter>force directory security mode</parameter></link></para></listitem>
821 <listitem><para><link linkend="FORCEGROUP"><parameter>force group</parameter></link></para></listitem>
822 <listitem><para><link linkend="FORCESECURITYMODE"><parameter>force security mode</parameter></link></para></listitem>
823 <listitem><para><link linkend="FORCEUSER"><parameter>force user</parameter></link></para></listitem>
824 <listitem><para><link linkend="FSTYPE"><parameter>fstype</parameter></link></para></listitem>
825 <listitem><para><link linkend="GROUP"><parameter>group</parameter></link></para></listitem>
826 <listitem><para><link linkend="GUESTACCOUNT"><parameter>guest account</parameter></link></para></listitem>
827 <listitem><para><link linkend="GUESTOK"><parameter>guest ok</parameter></link></para></listitem>
828 <listitem><para><link linkend="GUESTONLY"><parameter>guest only</parameter></link></para></listitem>
829 <listitem><para><link linkend="HIDEDOTFILES"><parameter>hide dot files</parameter></link></para></listitem>
830 <listitem><para><link linkend="HIDEFILES"><parameter>hide files</parameter></link></para></listitem>
831 <listitem><para><link linkend="HOSTSALLOW"><parameter>hosts allow</parameter></link></para></listitem>
832 <listitem><para><link linkend="HOSTSDENY"><parameter>hosts deny</parameter></link></para></listitem>
833 <listitem><para><link linkend="INCLUDE"><parameter>include</parameter></link></para></listitem>
834 <listitem><para><link linkend="INHERITACLS"><parameter>inherit acls</parameter></link></para></listitem>
835 <listitem><para><link linkend="INHERITPERMISSIONS"><parameter>inherit permissions</parameter></link></para></listitem>
836 <listitem><para><link linkend="INVALIDUSERS"><parameter>invalid users</parameter></link></para></listitem>
837 <listitem><para><link linkend="LEVEL2OPLOCKS"><parameter>level2 oplocks</parameter></link></para></listitem>
838 <listitem><para><link linkend="LOCKING"><parameter>locking</parameter></link></para></listitem>
839 <listitem><para><link linkend="LPPAUSECOMMAND"><parameter>lppause command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
840 <listitem><para><link linkend="LPQCOMMAND"><parameter>lpq command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
841 <listitem><para><link linkend="LPRESUMECOMMAND"><parameter>lpresume command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
842 <listitem><para><link linkend="LPRMCOMMAND"><parameter>lprm command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
843 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAGICOUTPUT"><parameter>magic output</parameter></link></para></listitem>
844 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAGICSCRIPT"><parameter>magic script</parameter></link></para></listitem>
845 <listitem><para><link linkend="MANGLECASE"><parameter>mangle case</parameter></link></para></listitem>
846 <listitem><para><link linkend="MANGLEDMAP"><parameter>mangled map</parameter></link></para></listitem>
847 <listitem><para><link linkend="MANGLEDNAMES"><parameter>mangled names</parameter></link></para></listitem>
848 <listitem><para><link linkend="MANGLINGCHAR"><parameter>mangling char</parameter></link></para></listitem>
849 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAPARCHIVE"><parameter>map archive</parameter></link></para></listitem>
850 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAPHIDDEN"><parameter>map hidden</parameter></link></para></listitem>
851 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAPSYSTEM"><parameter>map system</parameter></link></para></listitem>
852 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXCONNECTIONS"><parameter>max connections</parameter></link></para></listitem>
853 <listitem><para><link linkend="MAXPRINTJOBS"><parameter>max print jobs</parameter></link></para></listitem>
854 <listitem><para><link linkend="MINPRINTSPACE"><parameter>min print space</parameter></link></para></listitem>
855 <listitem><para><link linkend="MSDFSROOT"><parameter>msdfs root</parameter></link></para></listitem>
856 <listitem><para><link linkend="NTACLSUPPORT"><parameter>nt acl support</parameter></link></para></listitem>
857 <listitem><para><link linkend="ONLYGUEST"><parameter>only guest</parameter></link></para></listitem>
858 <listitem><para><link linkend="ONLYUSER"><parameter>only user</parameter></link></para></listitem>
859 <listitem><para><link linkend="OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT"><parameter>oplock contention limit</parameter></link></para></listitem>
860 <listitem><para><link linkend="OPLOCKS"><parameter>oplocks</parameter></link></para></listitem>
861 <listitem><para><link linkend="PATH"><parameter>path</parameter></link></para></listitem>
862 <listitem><para><link linkend="POSIXLOCKING"><parameter>posix locking</parameter></link></para></listitem>
863 <listitem><para><link linkend="POSTEXEC"><parameter>postexec</parameter></link></para></listitem>
864 <listitem><para><link linkend="POSTSCRIPT"><parameter>postscript</parameter></link></para></listitem>
865 <listitem><para><link linkend="PREEXEC"><parameter>preexec</parameter></link></para></listitem>
866 <listitem><para><link linkend="PREEXECCLOSE"><parameter>preexec close</parameter></link></para></listitem>
867 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRESERVECASE"><parameter>preserve case</parameter></link></para></listitem>
868 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTCOMMAND"><parameter>print command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
869 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTOK"><parameter>print ok</parameter></link></para></listitem>
870 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTABLE"><parameter>printable</parameter></link></para></listitem>
871 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTER"><parameter>printer</parameter></link></para></listitem>
872 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTERADMIN"><parameter>printer admin</parameter></link></para></listitem>
873 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTERDRIVER"><parameter>printer driver</parameter></link></para></listitem>
874 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTERDRIVERLOCATION"><parameter>printer driver location</parameter></link></para></listitem>
875 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTERNAME"><parameter>printer name</parameter></link></para></listitem>
876 <listitem><para><link linkend="PRINTING"><parameter>printing</parameter></link></para></listitem>
877 <listitem><para><link linkend="PUBLIC"><parameter>public</parameter></link></para></listitem>
878 <listitem><para><link linkend="QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"><parameter>queuepause command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
879 <listitem><para><link linkend="QUEUERESUMECOMMAND"><parameter>queueresume command</parameter></link></para></listitem>
880 <listitem><para><link linkend="READLIST"><parameter>read list</parameter></link></para></listitem>
881 <listitem><para><link linkend="READONLY"><parameter>read only</parameter></link></para></listitem>
882 <listitem><para><link linkend="ROOTPOSTEXEC"><parameter>root postexec</parameter></link></para></listitem>
883 <listitem><para><link linkend="ROOTPREEXEC"><parameter>root preexec</parameter></link></para></listitem>
884 <listitem><para><link linkend="ROOTPREEXECCLOSE"><parameter>root preexec close</parameter></link></para></listitem>
885 <listitem><para><link linkend="SECURITYMASK"><parameter>security mask</parameter></link></para></listitem>
886 <listitem><para><link linkend="SETDIRECTORY"><parameter>set directory</parameter></link></para></listitem>
887 <listitem><para><link linkend="SHAREMODES"><parameter>share modes</parameter></link></para></listitem>
888 <listitem><para><link linkend="SHORTPRESERVECASE"><parameter>short preserve case</parameter></link></para></listitem>
889 <listitem><para><link linkend="STATUS"><parameter>status</parameter></link></para></listitem>
890 <listitem><para><link linkend="STRICTALLOCATE"><parameter>strict allocate</parameter></link></para></listitem>
891 <listitem><para><link linkend="STRICTLOCKING"><parameter>strict locking</parameter></link></para></listitem>
892 <listitem><para><link linkend="STRICTSYNC"><parameter>strict sync</parameter></link></para></listitem>
893 <listitem><para><link linkend="SYNCALWAYS"><parameter>sync always</parameter></link></para></listitem>
894 <listitem><para><link linkend="USECLIENTDRIVER"><parameter>use client driver</parameter></link></para></listitem>
895 <listitem><para><link linkend="USER"><parameter>user</parameter></link></para></listitem>
896 <listitem><para><link linkend="USERNAME"><parameter>username</parameter></link></para></listitem>
897 <listitem><para><link linkend="USERS"><parameter>users</parameter></link></para></listitem>
898 <listitem><para><link linkend="VALIDUSERS"><parameter>valid users</parameter></link></para></listitem>
899 <listitem><para><link linkend="VETOFILES"><parameter>veto files</parameter></link></para></listitem>
900 <listitem><para><link linkend="VETOOPLOCKFILES"><parameter>veto oplock files</parameter></link></para></listitem>
901 <listitem><para><link linkend="VFSOBJECT"><parameter>vfs object</parameter></link></para></listitem>
902 <listitem><para><link linkend="VFSOPTIONS"><parameter>vfs options</parameter></link></para></listitem>
903 <listitem><para><link linkend="VOLUME"><parameter>volume</parameter></link></para></listitem>
904 <listitem><para><link linkend="WIDELINKS"><parameter>wide links</parameter></link></para></listitem>
905 <listitem><para><link linkend="WRITABLE"><parameter>writable</parameter></link></para></listitem>
906 <listitem><para><link linkend="WRITECACHESIZE"><parameter>write cache size</parameter></link></para></listitem>
907 <listitem><para><link linkend="WRITELIST"><parameter>write list</parameter></link></para></listitem>
908 <listitem><para><link linkend="WRITEOK"><parameter>write ok</parameter></link></para></listitem>
909 <listitem><para><link linkend="WRITEABLE"><parameter>writeable</parameter></link></para></listitem>
910 </itemizedlist>
912 </refsect1>
914 <refsect1>
915 <title>EXPLANATION OF EACH PARAMETER</title>
917 <variablelist>
920 <varlistentry>
921 <term><anchor id="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND">add printer command (G)</term>
922 <listitem><para>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing
923 support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, The MS Add
924 Printer Wizard (APW) icon is now also available in the
925 "Printers..." folder displayed a share listing. The APW
926 allows for printers to be add remotely to a Samba or Windows
927 NT/2000 print server.</para>
929 <para>For a Samba host this means that the printer must be
930 physically added to the underlying printing system. The <parameter>add
931 printer command</parameter> defines a script to be run which
932 will perform the necessary operations for adding the printer
933 to the print system and to add the appropriate service definition
934 to the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file in order that it can be
935 shared by <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command>
936 </ulink>.</para>
938 <para>The <parameter>add printer command</parameter> is
939 automatically invoked with the following parameter (in
940 order:</para>
942 <itemizedlist>
943 <listitem><para><parameter>printer name</parameter></para></listitem>
944 <listitem><para><parameter>share name</parameter></para></listitem>
945 <listitem><para><parameter>port name</parameter></para></listitem>
946 <listitem><para><parameter>driver name</parameter></para></listitem>
947 <listitem><para><parameter>location</parameter></para></listitem>
948 <listitem><para><parameter>Windows 9x driver location</parameter>
949 </para></listitem>
950 </itemizedlist>
952 <para>All parameters are filled in from the PRINTER_INFO_2 structure sent
953 by the Windows NT/2000 client with one exception. The "Windows 9x
954 driver location" parameter is included for backwards compatibility
955 only. The remaining fields in the structure are generated from answers
956 to the APW questions.</para>
958 <para>Once the <parameter>add printer command</parameter> has
959 been executed, <command>smbd</command> will reparse the <filename>
960 smb.conf</filename> to determine if the share defined by the APW
961 exists. If the sharename is still invalid, then <command>smbd
962 </command> will return an ACCESS_DENIED error to the client.</para>
964 <para>See also <link linkend="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>
965 delete printer command</parameter></link>, <link
966 linkend="printing"><parameter>printing</parameter></link>,
967 <link linkend="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"><parameter>show add
968 printer wizard</parameter></link></para>
970 <para>Default: <emphasis>none</emphasis></para>
971 <para>Example: <command>addprinter command = /usr/bin/addprinter
972 </command></para>
973 </listitem>
974 </varlistentry>
978 <varlistentry>
979 <term><anchor id="ADDSHARECOMMAND">add share command (G)</term>
980 <listitem><para>Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically
981 add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager. The
982 <parameter>add share command</parameter> is used to define an
983 external program or script which will add a new service definition
984 to <filename>smb.conf</filename>. In order to successfully
985 execute the <parameter>add share command</parameter>, <command>smbd</command>
986 requires that the administrator be connected using a root account (i.e.
987 uid == 0).
988 </para>
990 <para>
991 When executed, <command>smbd</command> will automatically invoke the
992 <parameter>add share command</parameter> with four parameters.
993 </para>
995 <itemizedlist>
996 <listitem><para><parameter>configFile</parameter> - the location
997 of the global <filename>smb.conf</filename> file.
998 </para></listitem>
1000 <listitem><para><parameter>shareName</parameter> - the name of the new
1001 share.
1002 </para></listitem>
1004 <listitem><para><parameter>pathName</parameter> - path to an **existing**
1005 directory on disk.
1006 </para></listitem>
1008 <listitem><para><parameter>comment</parameter> - comment string to associate
1009 with the new share.
1010 </para></listitem>
1011 </itemizedlist>
1013 <para>
1014 This parameter is only used for add file shares. To add printer shares,
1015 see the <link linkend="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>add printer
1016 command</parameter></link>.
1017 </para>
1019 <para>
1020 See also <link linkend="CHANGESHARECOMMAND"><parameter>change share
1021 command</parameter></link>, <link linkend="DELETESHARECOMMAND"><parameter>delete share
1022 command</parameter></link>.
1023 </para>
1025 <para>Default: <emphasis>none</emphasis></para>
1026 <para>Example: <command>add share command = /usr/local/bin/addshare</command></para>
1027 </listitem>
1028 </varlistentry>
1034 <varlistentry>
1035 <term><anchor id="ADDUSERSCRIPT">add user script (G)</term>
1036 <listitem><para>This is the full pathname to a script that will
1037 be run <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis> by <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)
1038 </ulink> under special circumstances described below.</para>
1040 <para>Normally, a Samba server requires that UNIX users are
1041 created for all users accessing files on this server. For sites
1042 that use Windows NT account databases as their primary user database
1043 creating these users and keeping the user list in sync with the
1044 Windows NT PDC is an onerous task. This option allows <ulink
1045 url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> to create the required UNIX users
1046 <emphasis>ON DEMAND</emphasis> when a user accesses the Samba server.</para>
1048 <para>In order to use this option, <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink>
1049 must <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> be set to <parameter>security = share</parameter>
1050 and <parameter>add user script</parameter>
1051 must be set to a full pathname for a script that will create a UNIX
1052 user given one argument of <parameter>%u</parameter>, which expands into
1053 the UNIX user name to create.</para>
1055 <para>When the Windows user attempts to access the Samba server,
1056 at login (session setup in the SMB protocol) time, <ulink url="smbd.8.html">
1057 smbd</ulink> contacts the <parameter>password server</parameter> and
1058 attempts to authenticate the given user with the given password. If the
1059 authentication succeeds then <command>smbd</command>
1060 attempts to find a UNIX user in the UNIX password database to map the
1061 Windows user into. If this lookup fails, and <parameter>add user script
1062 </parameter> is set then <command>smbd</command> will
1063 call the specified script <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis>, expanding
1064 any <parameter>%u</parameter> argument to be the user name to create.</para>
1066 <para>If this script successfully creates the user then <command>smbd
1067 </command> will continue on as though the UNIX user
1068 already existed. In this way, UNIX users are dynamically created to
1069 match existing Windows NT accounts.</para>
1071 <para>See also <link linkend="SECURITY"><parameter>
1072 security</parameter></link>, <link linkend="PASSWORDSERVER">
1073 <parameter>password server</parameter></link>,
1074 <link linkend="DELETEUSERSCRIPT"><parameter>delete user
1075 script</parameter></link>.</para>
1077 <para>Default: <command>add user script = &lt;empty string&gt;
1078 </command></para>
1080 <para>Example: <command>add user script = /usr/local/samba/bin/add_user
1081 %u</command></para>
1082 </listitem>
1083 </varlistentry>
1088 <varlistentry>
1089 <term><anchor id="ADMINUSERS">admin users (S)</term>
1090 <listitem><para>This is a list of users who will be granted
1091 administrative privileges on the share. This means that they
1092 will do all file operations as the super-user (root).</para>
1094 <para>You should use this option very carefully, as any user in
1095 this list will be able to do anything they like on the share,
1096 irrespective of file permissions.</para>
1098 <para>Default: <emphasis>no admin users</emphasis></para>
1100 <para>Example: <command>admin users = jason</command></para>
1101 </listitem>
1102 </varlistentry>
1106 <varlistentry>
1107 <term><anchor id="ALLOWHOSTS">allow hosts (S)</term>
1108 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="HOSTSALLOW">
1109 <parameter>hosts allow</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
1110 </varlistentry>
1114 <varlistentry>
1115 <term><anchor id="ALLOWTRUSTEDDOMAINS">allow trusted domains (G)</term>
1116 <listitem><para>This option only takes effect when the <link
1117 linkend="SECURITY"><parameter>security</parameter></link> option is set to
1118 <constant>server</constant> or <constant>domain</constant>.
1119 If it is set to no, then attempts to connect to a resource from
1120 a domain or workgroup other than the one which <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> is running
1121 in will fail, even if that domain is trusted by the remote server
1122 doing the authentication.</para>
1124 <para>This is useful if you only want your Samba server to
1125 serve resources to users in the domain it is a member of. As
1126 an example, suppose that there are two domains DOMA and DOMB. DOMB
1127 is trusted by DOMA, which contains the Samba server. Under normal
1128 circumstances, a user with an account in DOMB can then access the
1129 resources of a UNIX account with the same account name on the
1130 Samba server even if they do not have an account in DOMA. This
1131 can make implementing a security boundary difficult.</para>
1133 <para>Default: <command>allow trusted domains = yes</command></para>
1135 </listitem>
1136 </varlistentry>
1140 <varlistentry>
1141 <term><anchor id="ANNOUNCEAS">announce as (G)</term>
1142 <listitem><para>This specifies what type of server
1143 <ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command>nmbd</command></ulink>
1144 will announce itself as, to a network neighborhood browse
1145 list. By default this is set to Windows NT. The valid options
1146 are : "NT Server" (which can also be written as "NT"),
1147 "NT Workstation", "Win95" or "WfW" meaning Windows NT Server,
1148 Windows NT Workstation, Windows 95 and Windows for Workgroups
1149 respectively. Do not change this parameter unless you have a
1150 specific need to stop Samba appearing as an NT server as this
1151 may prevent Samba servers from participating as browser servers
1152 correctly.</para>
1154 <para>Default: <command>announce as = NT Server</command></para>
1156 <para>Example: <command>announce as = Win95</command></para>
1157 </listitem>
1158 </varlistentry>
1162 <varlistentry>
1163 <term><anchor id="ANNOUNCEVERSION">announce version (G)</term>
1164 <listitem><para>This specifies the major and minor version numbers
1165 that nmbd will use when announcing itself as a server. The default
1166 is 4.2. Do not change this parameter unless you have a specific
1167 need to set a Samba server to be a downlevel server.</para>
1169 <para>Default: <command>announce version = 4.5</command></para>
1171 <para>Example: <command>announce version = 2.0</command></para>
1172 </listitem>
1173 </varlistentry>
1177 <varlistentry>
1178 <term><anchor id="AUTOSERVICES">auto services (G)</term>
1179 <listitem><para>This is a synonym for the <link linkend="PRELOAD">
1180 <parameter>preload</parameter></link>.</para>
1181 </listitem>
1182 </varlistentry>
1186 <varlistentry>
1187 <term><anchor id="AVAILABLE">available (S)</term>
1188 <listitem><para>This parameter lets you "turn off" a service. If
1189 <parameter>available = no</parameter>, then <emphasis>ALL</emphasis>
1190 attempts to connect to the service will fail. Such failures are
1191 logged.</para>
1193 <para>Default: <command>available = yes</command></para>
1195 </listitem>
1196 </varlistentry>
1200 <varlistentry>
1201 <term><anchor id="BINDINTERFACESONLY">bind interfaces only (G)</term>
1202 <listitem><para>This global parameter allows the Samba admin
1203 to limit what interfaces on a machine will serve SMB requests. If
1204 affects file service <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> and
1205 name service <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> in slightly
1206 different ways.</para>
1208 <para>For name service it causes <command>nmbd</command> to bind
1209 to ports 137 and 138 on the interfaces listed in the <link
1210 linkend="INTERFACES">interfaces</link> parameter. <command>nmbd
1211 </command> also binds to the "all addresses" interface (0.0.0.0)
1212 on ports 137 and 138 for the purposes of reading broadcast messages.
1213 If this option is not set then <command>nmbd</command> will service
1214 name requests on all of these sockets. If <parameter>bind interfaces
1215 only</parameter> is set then <command>nmbd</command> will check the
1216 source address of any packets coming in on the broadcast sockets
1217 and discard any that don't match the broadcast addresses of the
1218 interfaces in the <parameter>interfaces</parameter> parameter list.
1219 As unicast packets are received on the other sockets it allows
1220 <command>nmbd</command> to refuse to serve names to machines that
1221 send packets that arrive through any interfaces not listed in the
1222 <parameter>interfaces</parameter> list. IP Source address spoofing
1223 does defeat this simple check, however so it must not be used
1224 seriously as a security feature for <command>nmbd</command>.</para>
1226 <para>For file service it causes <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink>
1227 to bind only to the interface list given in the <link linkend="INTERFACES">
1228 interfaces</link> parameter. This restricts the networks that
1229 <command>smbd</command> will serve to packets coming in those
1230 interfaces. Note that you should not use this parameter for machines
1231 that are serving PPP or other intermittent or non-broadcast network
1232 interfaces as it will not cope with non-permanent interfaces.</para>
1234 <para>If <parameter>bind interfaces only</parameter> is set then
1235 unless the network address <emphasis>127.0.0.1</emphasis> is added
1236 to the <parameter>interfaces</parameter> parameter list <ulink
1237 url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink>
1238 and <ulink url="swat.8.html"><command>swat(8)</command></ulink> may
1239 not work as expected due to the reasons covered below.</para>
1241 <para>To change a users SMB password, the <command>smbpasswd</command>
1242 by default connects to the <emphasis>localhost - 127.0.0.1</emphasis>
1243 address as an SMB client to issue the password change request. If
1244 <parameter>bind interfaces only</parameter> is set then unless the
1245 network address <emphasis>127.0.0.1</emphasis> is added to the
1246 <parameter>interfaces</parameter> parameter list then <command>
1247 smbpasswd</command> will fail to connect in it's default mode.
1248 <command>smbpasswd</command> can be forced to use the primary IP interface
1249 of the local host by using its <ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html#minusr">
1250 <parameter>-r <replaceable>remote machine</replaceable></parameter>
1251 </ulink> parameter, with <replaceable>remote machine</replaceable> set
1252 to the IP name of the primary interface of the local host.</para>
1254 <para>The <command>swat</command> status page tries to connect with
1255 <command>smbd</command> and <command>nmbd</command> at the address
1256 <emphasis>127.0.0.1</emphasis> to determine if they are running.
1257 Not adding <emphasis>127.0.0.1</emphasis> will cause <command>
1258 smbd</command> and <command>nmbd</command> to always show
1259 "not running" even if they really are. This can prevent <command>
1260 swat</command> from starting/stopping/restarting <command>smbd</command>
1261 and <command>nmbd</command>.</para>
1263 <para>Default: <command>bind interfaces only = no</command></para>
1265 </listitem>
1266 </varlistentry>
1270 <varlistentry>
1271 <term><anchor id="BLOCKINGLOCKS">blocking locks (S)</term>
1272 <listitem><para>This parameter controls the behavior of <ulink
1273 url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> when given a request by a client
1274 to obtain a byte range lock on a region of an open file, and the
1275 request has a time limit associated with it.</para>
1277 <para>If this parameter is set and the lock range requested
1278 cannot be immediately satisfied, Samba 2.2 will internally
1279 queue the lock request, and periodically attempt to obtain
1280 the lock until the timeout period expires.</para>
1282 <para>If this parameter is set to <constant>false</constant>, then
1283 Samba 2.2 will behave as previous versions of Samba would and
1284 will fail the lock request immediately if the lock range
1285 cannot be obtained.</para>
1287 <para>Default: <command>blocking locks = yes</command></para>
1289 </listitem>
1290 </varlistentry>
1294 <varlistentry>
1295 <term><anchor id="BROWSABLE">browsable (S)</term>
1296 <listitem><para>See the <link linkend="BROWSEABLE"><parameter>
1297 browseable</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
1298 </varlistentry>
1302 <varlistentry>
1303 <term><anchor id="BROWSELIST">browse list (G)</term>
1304 <listitem><para>This controls whether <ulink url="smbd.8.html">
1305 <command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> will serve a browse list to
1306 a client doing a <command>NetServerEnum</command> call. Normally
1307 set to <constant>true</constant>. You should never need to change
1308 this.</para>
1310 <para>Default: <command>browse list = yes</command></para></listitem>
1311 </varlistentry>
1315 <varlistentry>
1316 <term><anchor id="BROWSEABLE">browseable (S)</term>
1317 <listitem><para>This controls whether this share is seen in
1318 the list of available shares in a net view and in the browse list.</para>
1320 <para>Default: <command>browseable = yes</command></para>
1321 </listitem>
1322 </varlistentry>
1326 <varlistentry>
1327 <term><anchor id="CASESENSITIVE">case sensitive (S)</term>
1328 <listitem><para>See the discussion in the section <link
1329 linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">NAME MANGLING</link>.</para>
1331 <para>Default: <command>case sensitive = no</command></para>
1332 </listitem>
1333 </varlistentry>
1337 <varlistentry>
1338 <term><anchor id="CASESIGNAMES">casesignames (S)</term>
1339 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="CASESENSITIVE">case
1340 sensitive</link>.</para></listitem>
1341 </varlistentry>
1345 <varlistentry>
1346 <term><anchor id="CHANGENOTIFYTIMEOUT">change notify timeout (G)</term>
1347 <listitem><para>This SMB allows a client to tell a server to
1348 "watch" a particular directory for any changes and only reply to
1349 the SMB request when a change has occurred. Such constant scanning of
1350 a directory is expensive under UNIX, hence an <ulink url="smbd.8.html">
1351 <command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> daemon only performs such a scan
1352 on each requested directory once every <parameter>change notify
1353 timeout</parameter> seconds.</para>
1355 <para>Default: <command>change notify timeout = 60</command></para>
1356 <para>Example: <command>change notify timeout = 300</command></para>
1358 <para>Would change the scan time to every 5 minutes.</para></listitem>
1359 </varlistentry>
1363 <varlistentry>
1364 <term><anchor id="CHANGESHARECOMMAND">change share command (G)</term>
1365 <listitem><para>Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically
1366 add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager. The
1367 <parameter>change share command</parameter> is used to define an
1368 external program or script which will modify an existing service definition
1369 in <filename>smb.conf</filename>. In order to successfully
1370 execute the <parameter>change share command</parameter>, <command>smbd</command>
1371 requires that the administrator be connected using a root account (i.e.
1372 uid == 0).
1373 </para>
1375 <para>
1376 When executed, <command>smbd</command> will automatically invoke the
1377 <parameter>change share command</parameter> with four parameters.
1378 </para>
1380 <itemizedlist>
1381 <listitem><para><parameter>configFile</parameter> - the location
1382 of the global <filename>smb.conf</filename> file.
1383 </para></listitem>
1385 <listitem><para><parameter>shareName</parameter> - the name of the new
1386 share.
1387 </para></listitem>
1389 <listitem><para><parameter>pathName</parameter> - path to an **existing**
1390 directory on disk.
1391 </para></listitem>
1393 <listitem><para><parameter>comment</parameter> - comment string to associate
1394 with the new share.
1395 </para></listitem>
1396 </itemizedlist>
1398 <para>
1399 This parameter is only used modify existing file shares definitions. To modify
1400 printer shares, use the "Printers..." folder as seen when browsing the Samba host.
1401 </para>
1403 <para>
1404 See also <link linkend="ADDSHARECOMMAND"><parameter>add share
1405 command</parameter></link>, <link linkend="DELETESHARECOMMAND"><parameter>delete
1406 share command</parameter></link>.
1407 </para>
1409 <para>Default: <emphasis>none</emphasis></para>
1410 <para>Example: <command>change share command = /usr/local/bin/addshare</command></para>
1411 </listitem>
1412 </varlistentry>
1416 <varlistentry>
1417 <term><anchor id="CHARACTERSET">character set (G)</term>
1418 <listitem><para>This allows <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> to map incoming filenames
1419 from a DOS Code page (see the <link linkend="CLIENTCODEPAGE">client
1420 code page</link> parameter) to several built in UNIX character sets.
1421 The built in code page translations are:</para>
1423 <itemizedlist>
1424 <listitem><para><constant>ISO8859-1</constant> : Western European
1425 UNIX character set. The parameter <parameter>client code page</parameter>
1426 <emphasis>MUST</emphasis> be set to code page 850 if the
1427 <parameter>character set</parameter> parameter is set to
1428 <constant>ISO8859-1</constant> in order for the conversion to the
1429 UNIX character set to be done correctly.</para></listitem>
1431 <listitem><para><constant>ISO8859-2</constant> : Eastern European
1432 UNIX character set. The parameter <parameter>client code page
1433 </parameter> <emphasis>MUST</emphasis> be set to code page 852 if
1434 the <parameter> character set</parameter> parameter is set
1435 to <constant>ISO8859-2</constant> in order for the conversion
1436 to the UNIX character set to be done correctly. </para></listitem>
1438 <listitem><para><constant>ISO8859-5</constant> : Russian Cyrillic
1439 UNIX character set. The parameter <parameter>client code page
1440 </parameter> <emphasis>MUST</emphasis> be set to code page
1441 866 if the <parameter>character set </parameter> parameter is
1442 set to <constant>ISO8859-5</constant> in order for the conversion
1443 to the UNIX character set to be done correctly. </para></listitem>
1445 <listitem><para><constant>ISO8859-7</constant> : Greek UNIX
1446 character set. The parameter <parameter>client code page
1447 </parameter> <emphasis>MUST</emphasis> be set to code page
1448 737 if the <parameter>character set</parameter> parameter is
1449 set to <constant>ISO8859-7</constant> in order for the conversion
1450 to the UNIX character set to be done correctly.</para></listitem>
1452 <listitem><para><constant>KOI8-R</constant> : Alternate mapping
1453 for Russian Cyrillic UNIX character set. The parameter
1454 <parameter>client code page</parameter> <emphasis>MUST</emphasis>
1455 be set to code page 866 if the <parameter>character set</parameter>
1456 parameter is set to <constant>KOI8-R</constant> in order for the
1457 conversion to the UNIX character set to be done correctly.</para>
1458 </listitem>
1459 </itemizedlist>
1461 <para><emphasis>BUG</emphasis>. These MSDOS code page to UNIX character
1462 set mappings should be dynamic, like the loading of MS DOS code pages,
1463 not static.</para>
1465 <para>Normally this parameter is not set, meaning no filename
1466 translation is done.</para>
1468 <para>Default: <command>character set = &lt;empty string&gt;</command></para>
1469 <para>Example: <command>character set = ISO8859-1</command></para></listitem>
1470 </varlistentry>
1474 <varlistentry>
1475 <term><anchor id="CLIENTCODEPAGE">client code page (G)</term>
1476 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the DOS code page
1477 that the clients accessing Samba are using. To determine what code
1478 page a Windows or DOS client is using, open a DOS command prompt
1479 and type the command <command>chcp</command>. This will output
1480 the code page. The default for USA MS-DOS, Windows 95, and
1481 Windows NT releases is code page 437. The default for western
1482 European releases of the above operating systems is code page 850.</para>
1484 <para>This parameter tells <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink>
1485 which of the <filename>codepage.<replaceable>XXX</replaceable>
1486 </filename> files to dynamically load on startup. These files,
1487 described more fully in the manual page <ulink url="make_smbcodepage.1.html">
1488 <command>make_smbcodepage(1)</command></ulink>, tell <command>
1489 smbd</command> how to map lower to upper case characters to provide
1490 the case insensitivity of filenames that Windows clients expect.</para>
1492 <para>Samba currently ships with the following code page files :</para>
1494 <itemizedlist>
1495 <listitem><para>Code Page 437 - MS-DOS Latin US</para></listitem>
1496 <listitem><para>Code Page 737 - Windows '95 Greek</para></listitem>
1497 <listitem><para>Code Page 850 - MS-DOS Latin 1</para></listitem>
1498 <listitem><para>Code Page 852 - MS-DOS Latin 2</para></listitem>
1499 <listitem><para>Code Page 861 - MS-DOS Icelandic</para></listitem>
1500 <listitem><para>Code Page 866 - MS-DOS Cyrillic</para></listitem>
1501 <listitem><para>Code Page 932 - MS-DOS Japanese SJIS</para></listitem>
1502 <listitem><para>Code Page 936 - MS-DOS Simplified Chinese</para></listitem>
1503 <listitem><para>Code Page 949 - MS-DOS Korean Hangul</para></listitem>
1504 <listitem><para>Code Page 950 - MS-DOS Traditional Chinese</para></listitem>
1505 </itemizedlist>
1507 <para>Thus this parameter may have any of the values 437, 737, 850, 852,
1508 861, 932, 936, 949, or 950. If you don't find the codepage you need,
1509 read the comments in one of the other codepage files and the
1510 <command>make_smbcodepage(1)</command> man page and write one. Please
1511 remember to donate it back to the Samba user community.</para>
1513 <para>This parameter co-operates with the <parameter>valid
1514 chars</parameter> parameter in determining what characters are
1515 valid in filenames and how capitalization is done. If you set both
1516 this parameter and the <parameter>valid chars</parameter> parameter
1517 the <parameter>client code page</parameter> parameter
1518 <emphasis>MUST</emphasis> be set before the <parameter>valid
1519 chars</parameter> parameter in the <filename>smb.conf</filename>
1520 file. The <parameter>valid chars</parameter> string will then
1521 augment the character settings in the <parameter>client code page</parameter>
1522 parameter.</para>
1524 <para>If not set, <parameter>client code page</parameter> defaults
1525 to 850.</para>
1527 <para>See also : <link linkend="VALIDCHARS"><parameter>valid
1528 chars</parameter></link>, <link linkend="CODEPAGEDIRECTORY">
1529 <parameter>code page directory</parameter></link></para>
1531 <para>Default: <command>client code page = 850</command></para>
1532 <para>Example: <command>client code page = 936</command></para>
1533 </listitem>
1534 </varlistentry>
1539 <varlistentry>
1540 <term><anchor id="CODEPAGEDIRECTORY">code page directory (G)</term>
1541 <listitem><para>Define the location of the various client code page
1542 files.</para>
1544 <para>See also <link linkend="CLIENTCODEPAGE"><parameter>client
1545 code page</parameter></link></para>
1547 <para>Default: <command>code page directory = ${prefix}/lib/codepages
1548 </command></para>
1549 <para>Example: <command>code page directory = /usr/share/samba/codepages
1550 </command></para>
1551 </listitem>
1552 </varlistentry>
1558 <varlistentry>
1559 <term><anchor id="CODINGSYSTEM">coding system (G)</term>
1560 <listitem><para>This parameter is used to determine how incoming
1561 Shift-JIS Japanese characters are mapped from the incoming <link
1562 linkend="CLIENTCODEPAGE"><parameter>client code page</parameter>
1563 </link> used by the client, into file names in the UNIX filesystem.
1564 Only useful if <parameter>client code page</parameter> is set to
1565 932 (Japanese Shift-JIS). The options are :</para>
1567 <itemizedlist>
1568 <listitem><para><constant>SJIS</constant> - Shift-JIS. Does no
1569 conversion of the incoming filename.</para></listitem>
1571 <listitem><para><constant>JIS8, J8BB, J8BH, J8@B,
1572 J8@J, J8@H </constant> - Convert from incoming Shift-JIS to eight
1573 bit JIS code with different shift-in, shift out codes.</para></listitem>
1575 <listitem><para><constant>JIS7, J7BB, J7BH, J7@B, J7@J,
1576 J7@H </constant> - Convert from incoming Shift-JIS to seven bit
1577 JIS code with different shift-in, shift out codes.</para></listitem>
1579 <listitem><para><constant>JUNET, JUBB, JUBH, JU@B, JU@J, JU@H </constant>
1580 - Convert from incoming Shift-JIS to JUNET code with different shift-in,
1581 shift out codes.</para></listitem>
1583 <listitem><para><constant>EUC</constant> - Convert an incoming
1584 Shift-JIS character to EUC code.</para></listitem>
1586 <listitem><para><constant>HEX</constant> - Convert an incoming
1587 Shift-JIS character to a 3 byte hex representation, i.e.
1588 <constant>:AB</constant>.</para></listitem>
1590 <listitem><para><constant>CAP</constant> - Convert an incoming
1591 Shift-JIS character to the 3 byte hex representation used by
1592 the Columbia AppleTalk Program (CAP), i.e. <constant>:AB</constant>.
1593 This is used for compatibility between Samba and CAP.</para></listitem>
1594 </itemizedlist>
1596 <para>Default: <command>coding system = &lt;empty value&gt;</command>
1597 </para>
1598 </listitem>
1599 </varlistentry>
1603 <varlistentry>
1604 <term><anchor id="COMMENT">comment (S)</term>
1605 <listitem><para>This is a text field that is seen next to a share
1606 when a client does a queries the server, either via the network
1607 neighborhood or via <command>net view</command> to list what shares
1608 are available.</para>
1610 <para>If you want to set the string that is displayed next to the
1611 machine name then see the <link linkend="SERVERSTRING"><parameter>
1612 server string</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
1614 <para>Default: <emphasis>No comment string</emphasis></para>
1615 <para>Example: <command>comment = Fred's Files</command></para></listitem>
1616 </varlistentry>
1620 <varlistentry>
1621 <term><anchor id="CONFIGFILE">config file (G)</term>
1622 <listitem><para>This allows you to override the config file
1623 to use, instead of the default (usually <filename>smb.conf</filename>).
1624 There is a chicken and egg problem here as this option is set
1625 in the config file!</para>
1627 <para>For this reason, if the name of the config file has changed
1628 when the parameters are loaded then it will reload them from
1629 the new config file.</para>
1631 <para>This option takes the usual substitutions, which can
1632 be very useful.</para>
1634 <para>If the config file doesn't exist then it won't be loaded
1635 (allowing you to special case the config files of just a few
1636 clients).</para>
1638 <para>Example: <command>config file = /usr/local/samba/lib/smb.conf.%m
1639 </command></para></listitem>
1640 </varlistentry>
1644 <varlistentry>
1645 <term><anchor id="COPY">copy (S)</term>
1646 <listitem><para>This parameter allows you to "clone" service
1647 entries. The specified service is simply duplicated under the
1648 current service's name. Any parameters specified in the current
1649 section will override those in the section being copied.</para>
1651 <para>This feature lets you set up a 'template' service and
1652 create similar services easily. Note that the service being
1653 copied must occur earlier in the configuration file than the
1654 service doing the copying.</para>
1656 <para>Default: <emphasis>no value</emphasis></para>
1657 <para>Example: <command>copy = otherservice</command></para></listitem>
1658 </varlistentry>
1662 <varlistentry>
1663 <term><anchor id="CREATEMASK">create mask (S)</term>
1664 <listitem><para>A synonym for this parameter is
1665 <link linkend="CREATEMODE"><parameter>create mode</parameter>
1666 </link>.</para>
1668 <para>When a file is created, the necessary permissions are
1669 calculated according to the mapping from DOS modes to UNIX
1670 permissions, and the resulting UNIX mode is then bit-wise 'AND'ed
1671 with this parameter. This parameter may be thought of as a bit-wise
1672 MASK for the UNIX modes of a file. Any bit <emphasis>not</emphasis>
1673 set here will be removed from the modes set on a file when it is
1674 created.</para>
1676 <para>The default value of this parameter removes the
1677 'group' and 'other' write and execute bits from the UNIX modes.</para>
1679 <para>Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode created
1680 from this parameter with the value of the <link
1681 linkend="FORCECREATEMODE"><parameter>force create mode</parameter></link>
1682 parameter which is set to 000 by default.</para>
1684 <para>This parameter does not affect directory modes. See the
1685 parameter <link linkend="DIRECTORYMODE"><parameter>directory mode
1686 </parameter></link> for details.</para>
1688 <para>See also the <link linkend="FORCECREATEMODE"><parameter>force
1689 create mode</parameter></link> parameter for forcing particular mode
1690 bits to be set on created files. See also the <link linkend="DIRECTORYMODE">
1691 <parameter>directory mode</parameter></link> parameter for masking
1692 mode bits on created directories. See also the <link linkend="INHERITPERMISSIONS">
1693 <parameter>inherit permissions</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
1695 <para>Note that this parameter does not apply to permissions
1696 set by Windows NT/2000 ACL editors. If the administrator wishes to enforce
1697 a mask on access control lists also, they need to set the <link
1698 linkend="SECURITYMASK"><parameter>security mask</parameter></link>.</para>
1700 <para>Default: <command>create mask = 0744</command></para>
1701 <para>Example: <command>create mask = 0775</command></para></listitem>
1702 </varlistentry>
1706 <varlistentry>
1707 <term><anchor id="CREATEMODE">create mode (S)</term>
1708 <listitem><para>This is a synonym for <link linkend="CREATEMASK"><parameter>
1709 create mask</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
1710 </varlistentry>
1713 <varlistentry>
1714 <term><anchor id="CSCPOLICY">csc policy (S)</term>
1715 <listitem><para>This stands for <emphasis>client-side caching
1716 policy</emphasis>, and specifies how clients capable of offline
1717 caching will cache the files in the share. The valid values
1718 are: manual, documents, programs, disable.</para>
1720 <para>These values correspond to those used on Windows
1721 servers.</para>
1723 <para>For example, shares containing roaming profiles can have
1724 offline caching disabled using <command>csc policy = disable
1725 </command>.</para>
1727 <para>Default: <command>csc policy = manual</command></para>
1728 <para>Example: <command>csc policy = programs</command></para>
1729 </listitem>
1730 </varlistentry>
1732 <varlistentry>
1733 <term><anchor id="DEADTIME">deadtime (G)</term>
1734 <listitem><para>The value of the parameter (a decimal integer)
1735 represents the number of minutes of inactivity before a connection
1736 is considered dead, and it is disconnected. The deadtime only takes
1737 effect if the number of open files is zero.</para>
1739 <para>This is useful to stop a server's resources being
1740 exhausted by a large number of inactive connections.</para>
1742 <para>Most clients have an auto-reconnect feature when a
1743 connection is broken so in most cases this parameter should be
1744 transparent to users.</para>
1746 <para>Using this parameter with a timeout of a few minutes
1747 is recommended for most systems.</para>
1749 <para>A deadtime of zero indicates that no auto-disconnection
1750 should be performed.</para>
1752 <para>Default: <command>deadtime = 0</command></para>
1753 <para>Example: <command>deadtime = 15</command></para></listitem>
1754 </varlistentry>
1758 <varlistentry>
1759 <term><anchor id="DEBUGHIRESTIMESTAMP">debug hires timestamp (G)</term>
1760 <listitem><para>Sometimes the timestamps in the log messages
1761 are needed with a resolution of higher that seconds, this
1762 boolean parameter adds microsecond resolution to the timestamp
1763 message header when turned on.</para>
1765 <para>Note that the parameter <link linkend="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><parameter>
1766 debug timestamp</parameter></link> must be on for this to have an
1767 effect.</para>
1769 <para>Default: <command>debug hires timestamp = no</command></para>
1770 </listitem>
1771 </varlistentry>
1775 <varlistentry>
1776 <term><anchor id="DEBUGPID">debug pid (G)</term>
1777 <listitem><para>When using only one log file for more then one
1778 forked <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink>-process there may be hard to follow which process
1779 outputs which message. This boolean parameter is adds the process-id
1780 to the timestamp message headers in the logfile when turned on.</para>
1782 <para>Note that the parameter <link linkend="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><parameter>
1783 debug timestamp</parameter></link> must be on for this to have an
1784 effect.</para>
1786 <para>Default: <command>debug pid = no</command></para></listitem>
1787 </varlistentry>
1790 <varlistentry>
1791 <term><anchor id="DEBUGTIMESTAMP">debug timestamp (G)</term>
1792 <listitem><para>Samba 2.2 debug log messages are timestamped
1793 by default. If you are running at a high <link linkend="DEBUGLEVEL">
1794 <parameter>debug level</parameter></link> these timestamps
1795 can be distracting. This boolean parameter allows timestamping
1796 to be turned off.</para>
1798 <para>Default: <command>debug timestamp = yes</command></para></listitem>
1799 </varlistentry>
1803 <varlistentry>
1804 <term><anchor id="DEBUGUID">debug uid (G)</term>
1805 <listitem><para>Samba is sometimes run as root and sometime
1806 run as the connected user, this boolean parameter inserts the
1807 current euid, egid, uid and gid to the timestamp message headers
1808 in the log file if turned on.</para>
1810 <para>Note that the parameter <link linkend="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><parameter>
1811 debug timestamp</parameter></link> must be on for this to have an
1812 effect.</para>
1814 <para>Default: <command>debug uid = no</command></para></listitem>
1815 </varlistentry>
1819 <varlistentry>
1820 <term><anchor id="DEBUGLEVEL">debuglevel (G)</term>
1821 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="LOGLEVEL"><parameter>
1822 log level</parameter></link>.</para>
1823 </listitem>
1824 </varlistentry>
1828 <varlistentry>
1829 <term><anchor id="DEFAULT">default (G)</term>
1830 <listitem><para>A synonym for <link linkend="DEFAULTSERVICE"><parameter>
1831 default service</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
1832 </varlistentry>
1836 <varlistentry>
1837 <term><anchor id="DEFAULTCASE">default case (S)</term>
1838 <listitem><para>See the section on <link linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">
1839 NAME MANGLING</link>. Also note the <link linkend="SHORTPRESERVECASE">
1840 <parameter>short preserve case</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
1842 <para>Default: <command>default case = lower</command></para>
1843 </listitem>
1844 </varlistentry>
1848 <varlistentry>
1849 <term><anchor id="DEFAULTDEVMODE">default devmode (S)</term>
1850 <listitem><para>This parameter is only applicable to <link
1851 linkend="PRINTOK">printable</link> services. When smbd is serving
1852 Printer Drivers to Windows NT/2k/XP clients, each printer on the Samba
1853 server has a Device Mode which defines things such as paper size and
1854 orientation and duplex settings. The device mode can only correctly be
1855 generated by the printer driver itself (which can only be executed on a
1856 Win32 platform). Because smbd is unable to execute the driver code
1857 to generate the device mode, the default behavior is to set this field
1858 to NULL.
1859 </para>
1861 <para>Most problems with serving printer drivers to Windows NT/2k/XP clients
1862 can be traced to a problem with the generated device mode. Certain drivers
1863 will do things such as crashing the client's Explorer.exe with a NULL devmode.
1864 However, other printer drivers can cause the client's spooler service
1865 (spoolsv.exe) to die if the devmode was not created by the driver itself
1866 (i.e. smbd generates a default devmode).
1867 </para>
1869 <para>This parameter should be used with care and tested with the printer
1870 driver in question. It is better to leave the device mode to NULL
1871 and let the Windows client set the correct values. Because drivers do not
1872 do this all the time, setting <command>default devmode = yes</command>
1873 will instruct smbd to generate a default one.
1874 </para>
1876 <para>For more information on Windows NT/2k printing and Device Modes,
1877 see the <ulink url="http://msdn.microsoft.com/">MSDN documentation</ulink>.
1878 </para>
1880 <para>Default: <command>default devmode = no</command></para>
1881 </listitem>
1882 </varlistentry>
1886 <varlistentry>
1887 <term><anchor id="DEFAULTSERVICE">default service (G)</term>
1888 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the name of a service
1889 which will be connected to if the service actually requested cannot
1890 be found. Note that the square brackets are <emphasis>NOT</emphasis>
1891 given in the parameter value (see example below).</para>
1893 <para>There is no default value for this parameter. If this
1894 parameter is not given, attempting to connect to a nonexistent
1895 service results in an error.</para>
1897 <para>Typically the default service would be a <link linkend="GUESTOK">
1898 <parameter>guest ok</parameter></link>, <link linkend="READONLY">
1899 <parameter>read-only</parameter></link> service.</para>
1901 <para>Also note that the apparent service name will be changed
1902 to equal that of the requested service, this is very useful as it
1903 allows you to use macros like <parameter>%S</parameter> to make
1904 a wildcard service.</para>
1906 <para>Note also that any "_" characters in the name of the service
1907 used in the default service will get mapped to a "/". This allows for
1908 interesting things.</para>
1911 <para>Example:</para>
1913 <para><programlisting>
1914 [global]
1915 default service = pub
1917 [pub]
1918 path = /%S
1919 </programlisting></para>
1920 </listitem>
1921 </varlistentry>
1925 <varlistentry>
1926 <term><anchor id="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND">delete printer command (G)</term>
1927 <listitem><para>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printer
1928 support for Windows NT/2000 clients in Samba 2.2, it is now
1929 possible to delete printer at run time by issuing the
1930 DeletePrinter() RPC call.</para>
1932 <para>For a Samba host this means that the printer must be
1933 physically deleted from underlying printing system. The <parameter>
1934 deleteprinter command</parameter> defines a script to be run which
1935 will perform the necessary operations for removing the printer
1936 from the print system and from <filename>smb.conf</filename>.
1937 </para>
1939 <para>The <parameter>delete printer command</parameter> is
1940 automatically called with only one parameter: <parameter>
1941 "printer name"</parameter>.</para>
1944 <para>Once the <parameter>delete printer command</parameter> has
1945 been executed, <command>smbd</command> will reparse the <filename>
1946 smb.conf</filename> to associated printer no longer exists.
1947 If the sharename is still valid, then <command>smbd
1948 </command> will return an ACCESS_DENIED error to the client.</para>
1950 <para>See also <link linkend="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>
1951 add printer command</parameter></link>, <link
1952 linkend="printing"><parameter>printing</parameter></link>,
1953 <link linkend="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD"><parameter>show add
1954 printer wizard</parameter></link></para>
1956 <para>Default: <emphasis>none</emphasis></para>
1957 <para>Example: <command>deleteprinter command = /usr/bin/removeprinter
1958 </command></para>
1959 </listitem>
1960 </varlistentry>
1967 <varlistentry>
1968 <term><anchor id="DELETEREADONLY">delete readonly (S)</term>
1969 <listitem><para>This parameter allows readonly files to be deleted.
1970 This is not normal DOS semantics, but is allowed by UNIX.</para>
1972 <para>This option may be useful for running applications such
1973 as rcs, where UNIX file ownership prevents changing file
1974 permissions, and DOS semantics prevent deletion of a read only file.</para>
1976 <para>Default: <command>delete readonly = no</command></para></listitem>
1977 </varlistentry>
1981 <varlistentry>
1982 <term><anchor id="DELETESHARECOMMAND">delete share command (G)</term>
1983 <listitem><para>Samba 2.2.0 introduced the ability to dynamically
1984 add and delete shares via the Windows NT 4.0 Server Manager. The
1985 <parameter>delete share command</parameter> is used to define an
1986 external program or script which will remove an existing service
1987 definition from <filename>smb.conf</filename>. In order to successfully
1988 execute the <parameter>delete share command</parameter>, <command>smbd</command>
1989 requires that the administrator be connected using a root account (i.e.
1990 uid == 0).
1991 </para>
1993 <para>
1994 When executed, <command>smbd</command> will automatically invoke the
1995 <parameter>delete share command</parameter> with two parameters.
1996 </para>
1998 <itemizedlist>
1999 <listitem><para><parameter>configFile</parameter> - the location
2000 of the global <filename>smb.conf</filename> file.
2001 </para></listitem>
2003 <listitem><para><parameter>shareName</parameter> - the name of
2004 the existing service.
2005 </para></listitem>
2006 </itemizedlist>
2008 <para>
2009 This parameter is only used to remove file shares. To delete printer shares,
2010 see the <link linkend="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>delete printer
2011 command</parameter></link>.
2012 </para>
2014 <para>
2015 See also <link linkend="ADDSHARECOMMAND"><parameter>add share
2016 command</parameter></link>, <link linkend="CHANGESHARECOMMAND"><parameter>change
2017 share command</parameter></link>.
2018 </para>
2020 <para>Default: <emphasis>none</emphasis></para>
2021 <para>Example: <command>delete share command = /usr/local/bin/delshare</command></para>
2023 </listitem>
2024 </varlistentry>
2029 <varlistentry>
2030 <term><anchor id="DELETEUSERSCRIPT">delete user script (G)</term>
2031 <listitem><para>This is the full pathname to a script that will
2032 be run <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis> by <ulink url="smbd.8.html">
2033 <command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> under special circumstances
2034 described below.</para>
2036 <para>Normally, a Samba server requires that UNIX users are
2037 created for all users accessing files on this server. For sites
2038 that use Windows NT account databases as their primary user database
2039 creating these users and keeping the user list in sync with the
2040 Windows NT PDC is an onerous task. This option allows <command>
2041 smbd</command> to delete the required UNIX users <emphasis>ON
2042 DEMAND</emphasis> when a user accesses the Samba server and the
2043 Windows NT user no longer exists.</para>
2045 <para>In order to use this option, <command>smbd</command> must be
2046 set to <parameter>security = domain</parameter> or <parameter>security =
2047 user</parameter> and <parameter>delete user script</parameter>
2048 must be set to a full pathname for a script
2049 that will delete a UNIX user given one argument of <parameter>%u</parameter>,
2050 which expands into the UNIX user name to delete.</para>
2052 <para>When the Windows user attempts to access the Samba server,
2053 at <emphasis>login</emphasis> (session setup in the SMB protocol)
2054 time, <command>smbd</command> contacts the <link linkend="PASSWORDSERVER">
2055 <parameter>password server</parameter></link> and attempts to authenticate
2056 the given user with the given password. If the authentication fails
2057 with the specific Domain error code meaning that the user no longer
2058 exists then <command>smbd</command> attempts to find a UNIX user in
2059 the UNIX password database that matches the Windows user account. If
2060 this lookup succeeds, and <parameter>delete user script</parameter> is
2061 set then <command>smbd</command> will all the specified script
2062 <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis>, expanding any <parameter>%u</parameter>
2063 argument to be the user name to delete.</para>
2065 <para>This script should delete the given UNIX username. In this way,
2066 UNIX users are dynamically deleted to match existing Windows NT
2067 accounts.</para>
2069 <para>See also <link linkend="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN">security = domain</link>,
2070 <link linkend="PASSWORDSERVER"><parameter>password server</parameter>
2071 </link>, <link linkend="ADDUSERSCRIPT"><parameter>add user script</parameter>
2072 </link>.</para>
2074 <para>Default: <command>delete user script = &lt;empty string&gt;
2075 </command></para>
2076 <para>Example: <command>delete user script = /usr/local/samba/bin/del_user
2077 %u</command></para></listitem>
2078 </varlistentry>
2084 <varlistentry>
2085 <term><anchor id="DELETEVETOFILES">delete veto files (S)</term>
2086 <listitem><para>This option is used when Samba is attempting to
2087 delete a directory that contains one or more vetoed directories
2088 (see the <link linkend="VETOFILES"><parameter>veto files</parameter></link>
2089 option). If this option is set to <constant>false</constant> (the default) then if a vetoed
2090 directory contains any non-vetoed files or directories then the
2091 directory delete will fail. This is usually what you want.</para>
2093 <para>If this option is set to <constant>true</constant>, then Samba
2094 will attempt to recursively delete any files and directories within
2095 the vetoed directory. This can be useful for integration with file
2096 serving systems such as NetAtalk which create meta-files within
2097 directories you might normally veto DOS/Windows users from seeing
2098 (e.g. <filename>.AppleDouble</filename>)</para>
2100 <para>Setting <command>delete veto files = yes</command> allows these
2101 directories to be transparently deleted when the parent directory
2102 is deleted (so long as the user has permissions to do so).</para>
2104 <para>See also the <link linkend="VETOFILES"><parameter>veto
2105 files</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
2107 <para>Default: <command>delete veto files = no</command></para></listitem>
2108 </varlistentry>
2113 <varlistentry>
2114 <term><anchor id="DENYHOSTS">deny hosts (S)</term>
2115 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="HOSTSDENY"><parameter>hosts
2116 deny</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
2117 </varlistentry>
2122 <varlistentry>
2123 <term><anchor id="DFREECOMMAND">dfree command (G)</term>
2124 <listitem><para>The <parameter>dfree command</parameter> setting should
2125 only be used on systems where a problem occurs with the internal
2126 disk space calculations. This has been known to happen with Ultrix,
2127 but may occur with other operating systems. The symptom that was
2128 seen was an error of "Abort Retry Ignore" at the end of each
2129 directory listing.</para>
2131 <para>This setting allows the replacement of the internal routines to
2132 calculate the total disk space and amount available with an external
2133 routine. The example below gives a possible script that might fulfill
2134 this function.</para>
2136 <para>The external program will be passed a single parameter indicating
2137 a directory in the filesystem being queried. This will typically consist
2138 of the string <filename>./</filename>. The script should return two
2139 integers in ASCII. The first should be the total disk space in blocks,
2140 and the second should be the number of available blocks. An optional
2141 third return value can give the block size in bytes. The default
2142 blocksize is 1024 bytes.</para>
2144 <para>Note: Your script should <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> be setuid or
2145 setgid and should be owned by (and writeable only by) root!</para>
2147 <para>Default: <emphasis>By default internal routines for
2148 determining the disk capacity and remaining space will be used.
2149 </emphasis></para>
2151 <para>Example: <command>dfree command = /usr/local/samba/bin/dfree
2152 </command></para>
2154 <para>Where the script dfree (which must be made executable) could be:</para>
2156 <para><programlisting>
2157 #!/bin/sh
2158 df $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $2" "$4}'
2159 </programlisting></para>
2161 <para>or perhaps (on Sys V based systems):</para>
2163 <para><programlisting>
2164 #!/bin/sh
2165 /usr/bin/df -k $1 | tail -1 | awk '{print $3" "$5}'
2166 </programlisting></para>
2168 <para>Note that you may have to replace the command names
2169 with full path names on some systems.</para>
2170 </listitem>
2171 </varlistentry>
2176 <varlistentry>
2177 <term><anchor id="DIRECTORY">directory (S)</term>
2178 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="PATH"><parameter>path
2179 </parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
2180 </varlistentry>
2184 <varlistentry>
2185 <term><anchor id="DIRECTORYMASK">directory mask (S)</term>
2186 <listitem><para>This parameter is the octal modes which are
2187 used when converting DOS modes to UNIX modes when creating UNIX
2188 directories.</para>
2190 <para>When a directory is created, the necessary permissions are
2191 calculated according to the mapping from DOS modes to UNIX permissions,
2192 and the resulting UNIX mode is then bit-wise 'AND'ed with this
2193 parameter. This parameter may be thought of as a bit-wise MASK for
2194 the UNIX modes of a directory. Any bit <emphasis>not</emphasis> set
2195 here will be removed from the modes set on a directory when it is
2196 created.</para>
2198 <para>The default value of this parameter removes the 'group'
2199 and 'other' write bits from the UNIX mode, allowing only the
2200 user who owns the directory to modify it.</para>
2202 <para>Following this Samba will bit-wise 'OR' the UNIX mode
2203 created from this parameter with the value of the <link
2204 linkend="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"><parameter>force directory mode
2205 </parameter></link> parameter. This parameter is set to 000 by
2206 default (i.e. no extra mode bits are added).</para>
2208 <para>Note that this parameter does not apply to permissions
2209 set by Windows NT/2000 ACL editors. If the administrator wishes to enforce
2210 a mask on access control lists also, they need to set the <link
2211 linkend="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"><parameter>directory security mask</parameter></link>.</para>
2213 <para>See the <link linkend="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"><parameter>force
2214 directory mode</parameter></link> parameter to cause particular mode
2215 bits to always be set on created directories.</para>
2217 <para>See also the <link linkend="CREATEMODE"><parameter>create mode
2218 </parameter></link> parameter for masking mode bits on created files,
2219 and the <link linkend="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"><parameter>directory
2220 security mask</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
2222 <para>Also refer to the <link linkend="INHERITPERMISSIONS"><parameter>
2223 inherit permissions</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
2225 <para>Default: <command>directory mask = 0755</command></para>
2226 <para>Example: <command>directory mask = 0775</command></para>
2227 </listitem>
2228 </varlistentry>
2232 <varlistentry>
2233 <term><anchor id="DIRECTORYMODE">directory mode (S)</term>
2234 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="DIRECTORYMASK"><parameter>
2235 directory mask</parameter></link></para></listitem>
2236 </varlistentry>
2240 <varlistentry>
2241 <term><anchor id="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK">directory security mask (S)</term>
2242 <listitem><para>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits
2243 can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX
2244 permission on a directory using the native NT security dialog
2245 box.</para>
2247 <para>This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to
2248 the changed permission bits, thus preventing any bits not in
2249 this mask from being modified. Essentially, zero bits in this
2250 mask may be treated as a set of bits the user is not allowed
2251 to change.</para>
2253 <para>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to 0777
2254 meaning a user is allowed to modify all the user/group/world
2255 permissions on a directory.</para>
2257 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that users who can access the
2258 Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction,
2259 so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems.
2260 Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave
2261 it as the default of <constant>0777</constant>.</para>
2263 <para>See also the <link linkend="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"><parameter>
2264 force directory security mode</parameter></link>, <link
2265 linkend="SECURITYMASK"><parameter>security mask</parameter></link>,
2266 <link linkend="FORCESECURITYMODE"><parameter>force security mode
2267 </parameter></link> parameters.</para>
2269 <para>Default: <command>directory security mask = 0777</command></para>
2270 <para>Example: <command>directory security mask = 0700</command></para>
2271 </listitem>
2272 </varlistentry>
2276 <varlistentry>
2277 <term><anchor id="DISABLESPOOLSS">disable spoolss (G)</term>
2278 <listitem><para>Enabling this parameter will disables Samba's support
2279 for the SPOOLSS set of MS-RPC's and will yield identical behavior
2280 as Samba 2.0.x. Windows NT/2000 clients will downgrade to using
2281 Lanman style printing commands. Windows 9x/ME will be uneffected by
2282 the parameter. However, this will also disable the ability to upload
2283 printer drivers to a Samba server via the Windows NT Add Printer
2284 Wizard or by using the NT printer properties dialog window. It will
2285 also disable the capability of Windows NT/2000 clients to download
2286 print drivers from the Samba host upon demand.
2287 <emphasis>Be very careful about enabling this parameter.</emphasis>
2288 </para>
2290 <para>See also <link linkend="USECLIENTDRIVER">use client driver</link>
2291 </para>
2293 <para>Default : <command>disable spoolss = no</command></para>
2294 </listitem>
2295 </varlistentry>
2299 <varlistentry>
2300 <term><anchor id="DNSPROXY">dns proxy (G)</term>
2301 <listitem><para>Specifies that <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink>
2302 when acting as a WINS server and finding that a NetBIOS name has not
2303 been registered, should treat the NetBIOS name word-for-word as a DNS
2304 name and do a lookup with the DNS server for that name on behalf of
2305 the name-querying client.</para>
2307 <para>Note that the maximum length for a NetBIOS name is 15
2308 characters, so the DNS name (or DNS alias) can likewise only be
2309 15 characters, maximum.</para>
2311 <para><command>nmbd</command> spawns a second copy of itself to do the
2312 DNS name lookup requests, as doing a name lookup is a blocking
2313 action.</para>
2315 <para>See also the parameter <link linkend="WINSSUPPORT"><parameter>
2316 wins support</parameter></link>.</para>
2318 <para>Default: <command>dns proxy = yes</command></para></listitem>
2319 </varlistentry>
2323 <varlistentry>
2324 <term><anchor id="DOMAINADMINGROUP">domain admin group (G)</term>
2325 <listitem><para>This parameter is intended as a temporary solution
2326 to enable users to be a member of the "Domain Admins" group when
2327 a Samba host is acting as a PDC. A complete solution will be provided
2328 by a system for mapping Windows NT/2000 groups onto UNIX groups.
2329 Please note that this parameter has a somewhat confusing name. It
2330 accepts a list of usernames and of group names in standard
2331 <filename>smb.conf</filename> notation.
2332 </para>
2334 <para>See also <link linkend="DOMAINGUESTGROUP"><parameter>domain
2335 guest group</parameter></link>, <link linkend="DOMAINLOGONS"><parameter>domain
2336 logons</parameter></link>
2337 </para>
2339 <para>Default: <emphasis>no domain administrators</emphasis></para>
2340 <para>Example: <command>domain admin group = root @wheel</command></para>
2341 </listitem>
2342 </varlistentry>
2347 <varlistentry>
2348 <term><anchor id="DOMAINGUESTGROUP">domain guest group (G)</term>
2349 <listitem><para>This parameter is intended as a temporary solution
2350 to enable users to be a member of the "Domain Guests" group when
2351 a Samba host is acting as a PDC. A complete solution will be provided
2352 by a system for mapping Windows NT/2000 groups onto UNIX groups.
2353 Please note that this parameter has a somewhat confusing name. It
2354 accepts a list of usernames and of group names in standard
2355 <filename>smb.conf</filename> notation.
2356 </para>
2358 <para>See also <link linkend="DOMAINADMINGROUP"><parameter>domain
2359 admin group</parameter></link>, <link linkend="DOMAINLOGONS"><parameter>domain
2360 logons</parameter></link>
2361 </para>
2363 <para>Default: <emphasis>no domain guests</emphasis></para>
2364 <para>Example: <command>domain guest group = nobody @guest</command></para>
2365 </listitem>
2366 </varlistentry>
2369 <varlistentry>
2370 <term><anchor id="DOMAINLOGONS">domain logons (G)</term>
2371 <listitem><para>If set to <constant>true</constant>, the Samba server will serve
2372 Windows 95/98 Domain logons for the <link linkend="WORKGROUP">
2373 <parameter>workgroup</parameter></link> it is in. Samba 2.2 also
2374 has limited capability to act as a domain controller for Windows
2375 NT 4 Domains. For more details on setting up this feature see
2376 the Samba-PDC-HOWTO included in the <filename>htmldocs/</filename>
2377 directory shipped with the source code.</para>
2379 <para>Default: <command>domain logons = no</command></para></listitem>
2380 </varlistentry>
2384 <varlistentry>
2385 <term><anchor id="DOMAINMASTER">domain master (G)</term>
2386 <listitem><para>Tell <ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command>
2387 nmbd(8)</command></ulink> to enable WAN-wide browse list
2388 collation. Setting this option causes <command>nmbd</command> to
2389 claim a special domain specific NetBIOS name that identifies
2390 it as a domain master browser for its given <link linkend="WORKGROUP">
2391 <parameter>workgroup</parameter></link>. Local master browsers
2392 in the same <parameter>workgroup</parameter> on broadcast-isolated
2393 subnets will give this <command>nmbd</command> their local browse lists,
2394 and then ask <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>
2395 for a complete copy of the browse list for the whole wide area
2396 network. Browser clients will then contact their local master browser,
2397 and will receive the domain-wide browse list, instead of just the list
2398 for their broadcast-isolated subnet.</para>
2400 <para>Note that Windows NT Primary Domain Controllers expect to be
2401 able to claim this <parameter>workgroup</parameter> specific special
2402 NetBIOS name that identifies them as domain master browsers for
2403 that <parameter>workgroup</parameter> by default (i.e. there is no
2404 way to prevent a Windows NT PDC from attempting to do this). This
2405 means that if this parameter is set and <command>nmbd</command> claims
2406 the special name for a <parameter>workgroup</parameter> before a Windows
2407 NT PDC is able to do so then cross subnet browsing will behave
2408 strangely and may fail.</para>
2410 <para>If <link linkend="DOMAINLOGONS"><command>domain logons = yes</command>
2411 </link>, then the default behavior is to enable the <parameter>domain
2412 master</parameter> parameter. If <parameter>domain logons</parameter> is
2413 not enabled (the default setting), then neither will <parameter>domain
2414 master</parameter> be enabled by default.</para>
2416 <para>Default: <command>domain master = auto</command></para></listitem>
2417 </varlistentry>
2422 <varlistentry>
2423 <term><anchor id="DONTDESCEND">dont descend (S)</term>
2424 <listitem><para>There are certain directories on some systems
2425 (e.g., the <filename>/proc</filename> tree under Linux) that are either not
2426 of interest to clients or are infinitely deep (recursive). This
2427 parameter allows you to specify a comma-delimited list of directories
2428 that the server should always show as empty.</para>
2430 <para>Note that Samba can be very fussy about the exact format
2431 of the "dont descend" entries. For example you may need <filename>
2432 ./proc</filename> instead of just <filename>/proc</filename>.
2433 Experimentation is the best policy :-) </para>
2435 <para>Default: <emphasis>none (i.e., all directories are OK
2436 to descend)</emphasis></para>
2437 <para>Example: <command>dont descend = /proc,/dev</command></para>
2438 </listitem>
2439 </varlistentry>
2443 <varlistentry>
2444 <term><anchor id="DOSFILEMODE">dos filemode (S)</term>
2445 <listitem><para> The default behavior in Samba is to provide
2446 UNIX-like behavior where only the owner of a file/directory is
2447 able to change the permissions on it. However, this behavior
2448 is often confusing to DOS/Windows users. Enabling this parameter
2449 allows a user who has write access to the file (by whatever
2450 means) to modify the permissions on it. Note that a user
2451 belonging to the group owning the file will not be allowed to
2452 change permissions if the group is only granted read access.
2453 Ownership of the file/directory is not changed, only the permissions
2454 are modified.</para>
2456 <para>Default: <command>dos filemode = no</command></para>
2457 </listitem>
2458 </varlistentry>
2462 <varlistentry>
2463 <term><anchor id="DOSFILETIMERESOLUTION">dos filetime resolution (S)</term>
2464 <listitem><para>Under the DOS and Windows FAT filesystem, the finest
2465 granularity on time resolution is two seconds. Setting this parameter
2466 for a share causes Samba to round the reported time down to the
2467 nearest two second boundary when a query call that requires one second
2468 resolution is made to <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command>
2469 </ulink>.</para>
2471 <para>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for Visual
2472 C++ when used against Samba shares. If oplocks are enabled on a
2473 share, Visual C++ uses two different time reading calls to check if a
2474 file has changed since it was last read. One of these calls uses a
2475 one-second granularity, the other uses a two second granularity. As
2476 the two second call rounds any odd second down, then if the file has a
2477 timestamp of an odd number of seconds then the two timestamps will not
2478 match and Visual C++ will keep reporting the file has changed. Setting
2479 this option causes the two timestamps to match, and Visual C++ is
2480 happy.</para>
2482 <para>Default: <command>dos filetime resolution = no</command></para>
2483 </listitem>
2484 </varlistentry>
2488 <varlistentry>
2489 <term><anchor id="DOSFILETIMES">dos filetimes (S)</term>
2490 <listitem><para>Under DOS and Windows, if a user can write to a
2491 file they can change the timestamp on it. Under POSIX semantics,
2492 only the owner of the file or root may change the timestamp. By
2493 default, Samba runs with POSIX semantics and refuses to change the
2494 timestamp on a file if the user <command>smbd</command> is acting
2495 on behalf of is not the file owner. Setting this option to <constant>
2496 true</constant> allows DOS semantics and <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> will change the file
2497 timestamp as DOS requires.</para>
2499 <para>Default: <command>dos filetimes = no</command></para></listitem>
2500 </varlistentry>
2504 <varlistentry>
2505 <term><anchor id="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">encrypt passwords (G)</term>
2506 <listitem><para>This boolean controls whether encrypted passwords
2507 will be negotiated with the client. Note that Windows NT 4.0 SP3 and
2508 above and also Windows 98 will by default expect encrypted passwords
2509 unless a registry entry is changed. To use encrypted passwords in
2510 Samba see the file ENCRYPTION.txt in the Samba documentation
2511 directory <filename>docs/</filename> shipped with the source code.</para>
2513 <para>In order for encrypted passwords to work correctly
2514 <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> must either
2515 have access to a local <ulink url="smbpasswd.5.html"><filename>smbpasswd(5)
2516 </filename></ulink> file (see the <ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>
2517 smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink> program for information on how to set up
2518 and maintain this file), or set the <link
2519 linkend="SECURITY">security = [server|domain]</link> parameter which
2520 causes <command>smbd</command> to authenticate against another
2521 server.</para>
2523 <para>Default: <command>encrypt passwords = no</command></para></listitem>
2524 </varlistentry>
2527 <varlistentry>
2528 <term><anchor id="ENHANCEDBROWSING">enhanced browsing (G)</term>
2529 <listitem><para>This option enables a couple of enhancements to
2530 cross-subnet browse propagation that have been added in Samba
2531 but which are not standard in Microsoft implementations.
2532 </para>
2534 <para>The first enhancement to browse propagation consists of a regular
2535 wildcard query to a Samba WINS server for all Domain Master Browsers,
2536 followed by a browse synchronization with each of the returned
2537 DMBs. The second enhancement consists of a regular randomised browse
2538 synchronization with all currently known DMBs.</para>
2540 <para>You may wish to disable this option if you have a problem with empty
2541 workgroups not disappearing from browse lists. Due to the restrictions
2542 of the browse protocols these enhancements can cause a empty workgroup
2543 to stay around forever which can be annoying.</para>
2545 <para>In general you should leave this option enabled as it makes
2546 cross-subnet browse propagation much more reliable.</para>
2548 <para>Default: <command>enhanced browsing = yes</command></para>
2549 </listitem>
2550 </varlistentry>
2553 <varlistentry>
2554 <term><anchor id="ENUMPORTSCOMMAND">enumports command (G)</term>
2555 <listitem><para>The concept of a "port" is fairly foreign
2556 to UNIX hosts. Under Windows NT/2000 print servers, a port
2557 is associated with a port monitor and generally takes the form of
2558 a local port (i.e. LPT1:, COM1:, FILE:) or a remote port
2559 (i.e. LPD Port Monitor, etc...). By default, Samba has only one
2560 port defined--<constant>"Samba Printer Port"</constant>. Under
2561 Windows NT/2000, all printers must have a valid port name.
2562 If you wish to have a list of ports displayed (<command>smbd
2563 </command> does not use a port name for anything) other than
2564 the default <constant>"Samba Printer Port"</constant>, you
2565 can define <parameter>enumports command</parameter> to point to
2566 a program which should generate a list of ports, one per line,
2567 to standard output. This listing will then be used in response
2568 to the level 1 and 2 EnumPorts() RPC.</para>
2570 <para>Default: <emphasis>no enumports command</emphasis></para>
2571 <para>Example: <command>enumports command = /usr/bin/listports
2572 </command></para>
2573 </listitem>
2574 </varlistentry>
2576 <varlistentry>
2577 <term><anchor id="EXEC">exec (S)</term>
2578 <listitem><para>This is a synonym for <link linkend="PREEXEC">
2579 <parameter>preexec</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
2580 </varlistentry>
2584 <varlistentry>
2585 <term><anchor id="FAKEDIRECTORYCREATETIMES">fake directory create times (S)</term>
2586 <listitem><para>NTFS and Windows VFAT file systems keep a create
2587 time for all files and directories. This is not the same as the
2588 ctime - status change time - that Unix keeps, so Samba by default
2589 reports the earliest of the various times Unix does keep. Setting
2590 this parameter for a share causes Samba to always report midnight
2591 1-1-1980 as the create time for directories.</para>
2593 <para>This option is mainly used as a compatibility option for
2594 Visual C++ when used against Samba shares. Visual C++ generated
2595 makefiles have the object directory as a dependency for each object
2596 file, and a make rule to create the directory. Also, when NMAKE
2597 compares timestamps it uses the creation time when examining a
2598 directory. Thus the object directory will be created if it does not
2599 exist, but once it does exist it will always have an earlier
2600 timestamp than the object files it contains.</para>
2602 <para>However, Unix time semantics mean that the create time
2603 reported by Samba will be updated whenever a file is created or
2604 or deleted in the directory. NMAKE finds all object files in
2605 the object directory. The timestamp of the last one built is then
2606 compared to the timestamp of the object directory. If the
2607 directory's timestamp if newer, then all object files
2608 will be rebuilt. Enabling this option
2609 ensures directories always predate their contents and an NMAKE build
2610 will proceed as expected.</para>
2612 <para>Default: <command>fake directory create times = no</command></para>
2613 </listitem>
2614 </varlistentry>
2618 <varlistentry>
2619 <term><anchor id="FAKEOPLOCKS">fake oplocks (S)</term>
2620 <listitem><para>Oplocks are the way that SMB clients get permission
2621 from a server to locally cache file operations. If a server grants
2622 an oplock (opportunistic lock) then the client is free to assume
2623 that it is the only one accessing the file and it will aggressively
2624 cache file data. With some oplock types the client may even cache
2625 file open/close operations. This can give enormous performance benefits.
2626 </para>
2628 <para>When you set <command>fake oplocks = yes</command>, <ulink
2629 url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> will
2630 always grant oplock requests no matter how many clients are using
2631 the file.</para>
2633 <para>It is generally much better to use the real <link
2634 linkend="OPLOCKS"><parameter>oplocks</parameter></link> support rather
2635 than this parameter.</para>
2637 <para>If you enable this option on all read-only shares or
2638 shares that you know will only be accessed from one client at a
2639 time such as physically read-only media like CDROMs, you will see
2640 a big performance improvement on many operations. If you enable
2641 this option on shares where multiple clients may be accessing the
2642 files read-write at the same time you can get data corruption. Use
2643 this option carefully!</para>
2645 <para>Default: <command>fake oplocks = no</command></para></listitem>
2646 </varlistentry>
2650 <varlistentry>
2651 <term><anchor id="FOLLOWSYMLINKS">follow symlinks (S)</term>
2652 <listitem><para>This parameter allows the Samba administrator
2653 to stop <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>
2654 from following symbolic links in a particular share. Setting this
2655 parameter to <constant>no</constant> prevents any file or directory
2656 that is a symbolic link from being followed (the user will get an
2657 error). This option is very useful to stop users from adding a
2658 symbolic link to <filename>/etc/passwd</filename> in their home
2659 directory for instance. However it will slow filename lookups
2660 down slightly.</para>
2662 <para>This option is enabled (i.e. <command>smbd</command> will
2663 follow symbolic links) by default.</para>
2665 <para>Default: <command>follow symlinks = yes</command></para></listitem>
2666 </varlistentry>
2670 <varlistentry>
2671 <term><anchor id="FORCECREATEMODE">force create mode (S)</term>
2672 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit
2673 permissions that will <emphasis>always</emphasis> be set on a
2674 file created by Samba. This is done by bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto
2675 the mode bits of a file that is being created or having its
2676 permissions changed. The default for this parameter is (in octal)
2677 000. The modes in this parameter are bitwise 'OR'ed onto the file
2678 mode after the mask set in the <parameter>create mask</parameter>
2679 parameter is applied.</para>
2681 <para>See also the parameter <link linkend="CREATEMASK"><parameter>create
2682 mask</parameter></link> for details on masking mode bits on files.</para>
2684 <para>See also the <link linkend="INHERITPERMISSIONS"><parameter>inherit
2685 permissions</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
2687 <para>Default: <command>force create mode = 000</command></para>
2688 <para>Example: <command>force create mode = 0755</command></para>
2690 <para>would force all created files to have read and execute
2691 permissions set for 'group' and 'other' as well as the
2692 read/write/execute bits set for the 'user'.</para>
2693 </listitem>
2694 </varlistentry>
2698 <varlistentry>
2699 <term><anchor id="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE">force directory mode (S)</term>
2700 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies a set of UNIX mode bit
2701 permissions that will <emphasis>always</emphasis> be set on a directory
2702 created by Samba. This is done by bitwise 'OR'ing these bits onto the
2703 mode bits of a directory that is being created. The default for this
2704 parameter is (in octal) 0000 which will not add any extra permission
2705 bits to a created directory. This operation is done after the mode
2706 mask in the parameter <parameter>directory mask</parameter> is
2707 applied.</para>
2709 <para>See also the parameter <link linkend="DIRECTORYMASK"><parameter>
2710 directory mask</parameter></link> for details on masking mode bits
2711 on created directories.</para>
2713 <para>See also the <link linkend="INHERITPERMISSIONS"><parameter>
2714 inherit permissions</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
2716 <para>Default: <command>force directory mode = 000</command></para>
2717 <para>Example: <command>force directory mode = 0755</command></para>
2719 <para>would force all created directories to have read and execute
2720 permissions set for 'group' and 'other' as well as the
2721 read/write/execute bits set for the 'user'.</para>
2722 </listitem>
2723 </varlistentry>
2727 <varlistentry>
2728 <term><anchor id="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE">force directory
2729 security mode (S)</term>
2730 <listitem><para>This parameter controls what UNIX permission bits
2731 can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating the UNIX
2732 permission on a directory using the native NT security dialog box.</para>
2734 <para>This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the
2735 changed permission bits, thus forcing any bits in this mask that
2736 the user may have modified to be on. Essentially, one bits in this
2737 mask may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security
2738 on a directory, the user has always set to be 'on'.</para>
2740 <para>If not set explicitly this parameter is 000, which
2741 allows a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a
2742 directory without restrictions.</para>
2744 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that users who can access the
2745 Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction,
2746 so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems.
2747 Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave
2748 it set as 0000.</para>
2750 <para>See also the <link linkend="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"><parameter>
2751 directory security mask</parameter></link>, <link linkend="SECURITYMASK">
2752 <parameter>security mask</parameter></link>,
2753 <link linkend="FORCESECURITYMODE"><parameter>force security mode
2754 </parameter></link> parameters.</para>
2756 <para>Default: <command>force directory security mode = 0</command></para>
2757 <para>Example: <command>force directory security mode = 700</command></para>
2758 </listitem>
2759 </varlistentry>
2764 <varlistentry>
2765 <term><anchor id="FORCEGROUP">force group (S)</term>
2766 <listitem><para>This specifies a UNIX group name that will be
2767 assigned as the default primary group for all users connecting
2768 to this service. This is useful for sharing files by ensuring
2769 that all access to files on service will use the named group for
2770 their permissions checking. Thus, by assigning permissions for this
2771 group to the files and directories within this service the Samba
2772 administrator can restrict or allow sharing of these files.</para>
2774 <para>In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter has extended
2775 functionality in the following way. If the group name listed here
2776 has a '+' character prepended to it then the current user accessing
2777 the share only has the primary group default assigned to this group
2778 if they are already assigned as a member of that group. This allows
2779 an administrator to decide that only users who are already in a
2780 particular group will create files with group ownership set to that
2781 group. This gives a finer granularity of ownership assignment. For
2782 example, the setting <filename>force group = +sys</filename> means
2783 that only users who are already in group sys will have their default
2784 primary group assigned to sys when accessing this Samba share. All
2785 other users will retain their ordinary primary group.</para>
2787 <para>If the <link linkend="FORCEUSER"><parameter>force user
2788 </parameter></link> parameter is also set the group specified in
2789 <parameter>force group</parameter> will override the primary group
2790 set in <parameter>force user</parameter>.</para>
2792 <para>See also <link linkend="FORCEUSER"><parameter>force
2793 user</parameter></link>.</para>
2795 <para>Default: <emphasis>no forced group</emphasis></para>
2796 <para>Example: <command>force group = agroup</command></para>
2797 </listitem>
2798 </varlistentry>
2802 <varlistentry>
2803 <term><anchor id="FORCESECURITYMODE">force security mode (S)</term>
2804 <listitem><para>This parameter controls what UNIX permission
2805 bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating
2806 the UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security dialog
2807 box.</para>
2809 <para>This parameter is applied as a mask (OR'ed with) to the
2810 changed permission bits, thus forcing any bits in this mask that
2811 the user may have modified to be on. Essentially, one bits in this
2812 mask may be treated as a set of bits that, when modifying security
2813 on a file, the user has always set to be 'on'.</para>
2815 <para>If not set explicitly this parameter is set to 0,
2816 and allows a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file,
2817 with no restrictions.</para>
2819 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that users who can access
2820 the Samba server through other means can easily bypass this restriction,
2821 so it is primarily useful for standalone "appliance" systems.
2822 Administrators of most normal systems will probably want to leave
2823 this set to 0000.</para>
2825 <para>See also the <link linkend="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE"><parameter>
2826 force directory security mode</parameter></link>,
2827 <link linkend="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"><parameter>directory security
2828 mask</parameter></link>, <link linkend="SECURITYMASK"><parameter>
2829 security mask</parameter></link> parameters.</para>
2831 <para>Default: <command>force security mode = 0</command></para>
2832 <para>Example: <command>force security mode = 700</command></para>
2833 </listitem>
2834 </varlistentry>
2838 <varlistentry>
2839 <term><anchor id="FORCEUSER">force user (S)</term>
2840 <listitem><para>This specifies a UNIX user name that will be
2841 assigned as the default user for all users connecting to this service.
2842 This is useful for sharing files. You should also use it carefully
2843 as using it incorrectly can cause security problems.</para>
2845 <para>This user name only gets used once a connection is established.
2846 Thus clients still need to connect as a valid user and supply a
2847 valid password. Once connected, all file operations will be performed
2848 as the "forced user", no matter what username the client connected
2849 as. This can be very useful.</para>
2851 <para>In Samba 2.0.5 and above this parameter also causes the
2852 primary group of the forced user to be used as the primary group
2853 for all file activity. Prior to 2.0.5 the primary group was left
2854 as the primary group of the connecting user (this was a bug).</para>
2856 <para>See also <link linkend="FORCEGROUP"><parameter>force group
2857 </parameter></link></para>
2859 <para>Default: <emphasis>no forced user</emphasis></para>
2860 <para>Example: <command>force user = auser</command></para>
2861 </listitem>
2862 </varlistentry>
2866 <varlistentry>
2867 <term><anchor id="FSTYPE">fstype (S)</term>
2868 <listitem><para>This parameter allows the administrator to
2869 configure the string that specifies the type of filesystem a share
2870 is using that is reported by <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)
2871 </command></ulink> when a client queries the filesystem type
2872 for a share. The default type is <constant>NTFS</constant> for
2873 compatibility with Windows NT but this can be changed to other
2874 strings such as <constant>Samba</constant> or <constant>FAT
2875 </constant> if required.</para>
2877 <para>Default: <command>fstype = NTFS</command></para>
2878 <para>Example: <command>fstype = Samba</command></para></listitem>
2879 </varlistentry>
2883 <varlistentry>
2884 <term><anchor id="GETWDCACHE">getwd cache (G)</term>
2885 <listitem><para>This is a tuning option. When this is enabled a
2886 caching algorithm will be used to reduce the time taken for getwd()
2887 calls. This can have a significant impact on performance, especially
2888 when the <link linkend="WIDELINKS"><parameter>wide links</parameter>
2889 </link>parameter is set to <constant>false</constant>.</para>
2891 <para>Default: <command>getwd cache = yes</command></para>
2892 </listitem>
2893 </varlistentry>
2897 <varlistentry>
2898 <term><anchor id="GROUP">group (S)</term>
2899 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="FORCEGROUP"><parameter>force
2900 group</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
2901 </varlistentry>
2905 <varlistentry>
2906 <term><anchor id="GUESTACCOUNT">guest account (S)</term>
2907 <listitem><para>This is a username which will be used for access
2908 to services which are specified as <link linkend="GUESTOK"><parameter>
2909 guest ok</parameter></link> (see below). Whatever privileges this
2910 user has will be available to any client connecting to the guest service.
2911 Typically this user will exist in the password file, but will not
2912 have a valid login. The user account "ftp" is often a good choice
2913 for this parameter. If a username is specified in a given service,
2914 the specified username overrides this one.</para>
2916 <para>One some systems the default guest account "nobody" may not
2917 be able to print. Use another account in this case. You should test
2918 this by trying to log in as your guest user (perhaps by using the
2919 <command>su -</command> command) and trying to print using the
2920 system print command such as <command>lpr(1)</command> or <command>
2921 lp(1)</command>.</para>
2923 <para>Default: <emphasis>specified at compile time, usually
2924 "nobody"</emphasis></para>
2926 <para>Example: <command>guest account = ftp</command></para></listitem>
2927 </varlistentry>
2931 <varlistentry>
2932 <term><anchor id="GUESTOK">guest ok (S)</term>
2933 <listitem><para>If this parameter is <constant>yes</constant> for
2934 a service, then no password is required to connect to the service.
2935 Privileges will be those of the <link linkend="GUESTACCOUNT"><parameter>
2936 guest account</parameter></link>.</para>
2938 <para>See the section below on <link linkend="SECURITY"><parameter>
2939 security</parameter></link> for more information about this option.
2940 </para>
2942 <para>Default: <command>guest ok = no</command></para></listitem>
2943 </varlistentry>
2947 <varlistentry>
2948 <term><anchor id="GUESTONLY">guest only (S)</term>
2949 <listitem><para>If this parameter is <constant>yes</constant> for
2950 a service, then only guest connections to the service are permitted.
2951 This parameter will have no effect if <link linkend="GUESTOK">
2952 <parameter>guest ok</parameter></link> is not set for the service.</para>
2954 <para>See the section below on <link linkend="SECURITY"><parameter>
2955 security</parameter></link> for more information about this option.
2956 </para>
2958 <para>Default: <command>guest only = no</command></para></listitem>
2959 </varlistentry>
2963 <varlistentry>
2964 <term><anchor id="HIDEDOTFILES">hide dot files (S)</term>
2965 <listitem><para>This is a boolean parameter that controls whether
2966 files starting with a dot appear as hidden files.</para>
2968 <para>Default: <command>hide dot files = yes</command></para></listitem>
2969 </varlistentry>
2973 <varlistentry>
2974 <term><anchor id="HIDEFILES">hide files(S)</term>
2975 <listitem><para>This is a list of files or directories that are not
2976 visible but are accessible. The DOS 'hidden' attribute is applied
2977 to any files or directories that match.</para>
2979 <para>Each entry in the list must be separated by a '/',
2980 which allows spaces to be included in the entry. '*'
2981 and '?' can be used to specify multiple files or directories
2982 as in DOS wildcards.</para>
2984 <para>Each entry must be a Unix path, not a DOS path and must
2985 not include the Unix directory separator '/'.</para>
2987 <para>Note that the case sensitivity option is applicable
2988 in hiding files.</para>
2990 <para>Setting this parameter will affect the performance of Samba,
2991 as it will be forced to check all files and directories for a match
2992 as they are scanned.</para>
2994 <para>See also <link linkend="HIDEDOTFILES"><parameter>hide
2995 dot files</parameter></link>, <link linkend="VETOFILES"><parameter>
2996 veto files</parameter></link> and <link linkend="CASESENSITIVE">
2997 <parameter>case sensitive</parameter></link>.</para>
2999 <para>Default: <emphasis>no file are hidden</emphasis></para>
3000 <para>Example: <command>hide files =
3001 /.*/DesktopFolderDB/TrashFor%m/resource.frk/</command></para>
3003 <para>The above example is based on files that the Macintosh
3004 SMB client (DAVE) available from <ulink url="http://www.thursby.com">
3005 Thursby</ulink> creates for internal use, and also still hides
3006 all files beginning with a dot.</para></listitem>
3007 </varlistentry>
3011 <varlistentry>
3012 <term><anchor id="HIDELOCALUSERS">hide local users(G)</term>
3013 <listitem><para>This parameter toggles the hiding of local UNIX
3014 users (root, wheel, floppy, etc) from remote clients.</para>
3016 <para>Default: <command>hide local users = no</command></para></listitem>
3017 </varlistentry>
3021 <varlistentry>
3022 <term><anchor id="HIDEUNREADABLE">hide unreadable (S)</term>
3023 <listitem><para>This parameter prevents clients from seeing the
3024 existance of files that cannot be read. Defaults to off.</para>
3026 <para>Default: <command>hide unreadable = no</command></para></listitem>
3027 </varlistentry>
3031 <varlistentry>
3032 <term><anchor id="HOMEDIRMAP">homedir map (G)</term>
3033 <listitem><para>If<link linkend="NISHOMEDIR"><parameter>nis homedir
3034 </parameter></link> is <constant>true</constant>, and <ulink
3035 url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink> is also acting
3036 as a Win95/98 <parameter>logon server</parameter> then this parameter
3037 specifies the NIS (or YP) map from which the server for the user's
3038 home directory should be extracted. At present, only the Sun
3039 auto.home map format is understood. The form of the map is:</para>
3041 <para><command>username server:/some/file/system</command></para>
3043 <para>and the program will extract the servername from before
3044 the first ':'. There should probably be a better parsing system
3045 that copes with different map formats and also Amd (another
3046 automounter) maps.</para>
3048 <para><emphasis>NOTE :</emphasis>A working NIS client is required on
3049 the system for this option to work.</para>
3051 <para>See also <link linkend="NISHOMEDIR"><parameter>nis homedir</parameter>
3052 </link>, <link linkend="DOMAINLOGONS"><parameter>domain logons</parameter>
3053 </link>.</para>
3055 <para>Default: <command>homedir map = &lt;empty string&gt;</command></para>
3056 <para>Example: <command>homedir map = amd.homedir</command></para>
3057 </listitem>
3058 </varlistentry>
3064 <varlistentry>
3065 <term><anchor id="HOSTMSDFS">host msdfs (G)</term>
3066 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter is only available
3067 if Samba has been configured and compiled with the <command>
3068 --with-msdfs</command> option. If set to <constant>yes</constant>,
3069 Samba will act as a Dfs server, and allow Dfs-aware clients
3070 to browse Dfs trees hosted on the server.</para>
3072 <para>See also the <link linkend="MSDFSROOT"><parameter>
3073 msdfs root</parameter></link> share level parameter. For
3074 more information on setting up a Dfs tree on Samba,
3075 refer to <ulink url="msdfs_setup.html">msdfs_setup.html</ulink>.
3076 </para>
3078 <para>Default: <command>host msdfs = no</command></para>
3079 </listitem>
3080 </varlistentry>
3083 <varlistentry>
3084 <term><anchor id="HOSTSALLOW">hosts allow (S)</term>
3085 <listitem><para>A synonym for this parameter is <parameter>allow
3086 hosts</parameter>.</para>
3088 <para>This parameter is a comma, space, or tab delimited
3089 set of hosts which are permitted to access a service.</para>
3091 <para>If specified in the [global] section then it will
3092 apply to all services, regardless of whether the individual
3093 service has a different setting.</para>
3095 <para>You can specify the hosts by name or IP number. For
3096 example, you could restrict access to only the hosts on a
3097 Class C subnet with something like <command>allow hosts = 150.203.5.
3098 </command>. The full syntax of the list is described in the man
3099 page <filename>hosts_access(5)</filename>. Note that this man
3100 page may not be present on your system, so a brief description will
3101 be given here also.</para>
3103 <para>Note that the localhost address 127.0.0.1 will always
3104 be allowed access unless specifically denied by a <link
3105 linkend="HOSTSDENY"><parameter>hosts deny</parameter></link> option.</para>
3107 <para>You can also specify hosts by network/netmask pairs and
3108 by netgroup names if your system supports netgroups. The
3109 <emphasis>EXCEPT</emphasis> keyword can also be used to limit a
3110 wildcard list. The following examples may provide some help:</para>
3112 <para>Example 1: allow all IPs in 150.203.*.*; except one</para>
3114 <para><command>hosts allow = 150.203. EXCEPT 150.203.6.66</command></para>
3116 <para>Example 2: allow hosts that match the given network/netmask</para>
3118 <para><command>hosts allow = 150.203.15.0/255.255.255.0</command></para>
3120 <para>Example 3: allow a couple of hosts</para>
3122 <para><command>hosts allow = lapland, arvidsjaur</command></para>
3124 <para>Example 4: allow only hosts in NIS netgroup "foonet", but
3125 deny access from one particular host</para>
3127 <para><command>hosts allow = @foonet</command></para>
3129 <para><command>hosts deny = pirate</command></para>
3131 <para>Note that access still requires suitable user-level passwords.</para>
3133 <para>See <ulink url="testparm.1.html"><command>testparm(1)</command>
3134 </ulink> for a way of testing your host access to see if it does
3135 what you expect.</para>
3137 <para>Default: <emphasis>none (i.e., all hosts permitted access)
3138 </emphasis></para>
3140 <para>Example: <command>allow hosts = 150.203.5. myhost.mynet.edu.au
3141 </command></para>
3142 </listitem>
3143 </varlistentry>
3147 <varlistentry>
3148 <term><anchor id="HOSTSDENY">hosts deny (S)</term>
3149 <listitem><para>The opposite of <parameter>hosts allow</parameter>
3150 - hosts listed here are <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> permitted access to
3151 services unless the specific services have their own lists to override
3152 this one. Where the lists conflict, the <parameter>allow</parameter>
3153 list takes precedence.</para>
3155 <para>Default: <emphasis>none (i.e., no hosts specifically excluded)
3156 </emphasis></para>
3158 <para>Example: <command>hosts deny = 150.203.4. badhost.mynet.edu.au
3159 </command></para></listitem>
3160 </varlistentry>
3164 <varlistentry>
3165 <term><anchor id="HOSTSEQUIV">hosts equiv (G)</term>
3166 <listitem><para>If this global parameter is a non-null string,
3167 it specifies the name of a file to read for the names of hosts
3168 and users who will be allowed access without specifying a password.
3169 </para>
3171 <para>This is not be confused with <link linkend="HOSTSALLOW">
3172 <parameter>hosts allow</parameter></link> which is about hosts
3173 access to services and is more useful for guest services. <parameter>
3174 hosts equiv</parameter> may be useful for NT clients which will
3175 not supply passwords to Samba.</para>
3177 <para><emphasis>NOTE :</emphasis> The use of <parameter>hosts equiv
3178 </parameter> can be a major security hole. This is because you are
3179 trusting the PC to supply the correct username. It is very easy to
3180 get a PC to supply a false username. I recommend that the
3181 <parameter>hosts equiv</parameter> option be only used if you really
3182 know what you are doing, or perhaps on a home network where you trust
3183 your spouse and kids. And only if you <emphasis>really</emphasis> trust
3184 them :-).</para>
3186 <para>Default: <emphasis>no host equivalences</emphasis></para>
3187 <para>Example: <command>hosts equiv = /etc/hosts.equiv</command></para>
3188 </listitem>
3189 </varlistentry>
3193 <varlistentry>
3194 <term><anchor id="INCLUDE">include (G)</term>
3195 <listitem><para>This allows you to include one config file
3196 inside another. The file is included literally, as though typed
3197 in place.</para>
3199 <para>It takes the standard substitutions, except <parameter>%u
3200 </parameter>, <parameter>%P</parameter> and <parameter>%S</parameter>.
3201 </para>
3203 <para>Default: <emphasis>no file included</emphasis></para>
3204 <para>Example: <command>include = /usr/local/samba/lib/admin_smb.conf
3205 </command></para></listitem>
3206 </varlistentry>
3210 <varlistentry>
3211 <term><anchor id="INHERITACLS">inherit acls (S)</term>
3212 <listitem><para>This parameter can be used to ensure
3213 that if default acls exist on parent directories,
3214 they are always honored when creating a subdirectory.
3215 The default behavior is to use the mode specified
3216 when creating the directory. Enabling this option
3217 sets the mode to 0777, thus guaranteeing that
3218 default directory acls are propagated.
3219 </para>
3221 <para>Default: <command>inherit acls = no</command>
3222 </para></listitem>
3223 </varlistentry>
3228 <varlistentry>
3229 <term><anchor id="INHERITPERMISSIONS">inherit permissions (S)</term>
3230 <listitem><para>The permissions on new files and directories
3231 are normally governed by <link linkend="CREATEMASK"><parameter>
3232 create mask</parameter></link>, <link linkend="DIRECTORYMASK">
3233 <parameter>directory mask</parameter></link>, <link
3234 linkend="FORCECREATEMODE"><parameter>force create mode</parameter>
3235 </link> and <link linkend="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"><parameter>force
3236 directory mode</parameter></link> but the boolean inherit
3237 permissions parameter overrides this.</para>
3239 <para>New directories inherit the mode of the parent directory,
3240 including bits such as setgid.</para>
3242 <para>New files inherit their read/write bits from the parent
3243 directory. Their execute bits continue to be determined by
3244 <link linkend="MAPARCHIVE"><parameter>map archive</parameter>
3245 </link>, <link linkend="MAPHIDDEN"><parameter>map hidden</parameter>
3246 </link> and <link linkend="MAPSYSTEM"><parameter>map system</parameter>
3247 </link> as usual.</para>
3249 <para>Note that the setuid bit is <emphasis>never</emphasis> set via
3250 inheritance (the code explicitly prohibits this).</para>
3252 <para>This can be particularly useful on large systems with
3253 many users, perhaps several thousand, to allow a single [homes]
3254 share to be used flexibly by each user.</para>
3256 <para>See also <link linkend="CREATEMASK"><parameter>create mask
3257 </parameter></link>, <link linkend="DIRECTORYMASK"><parameter>
3258 directory mask</parameter></link>, <link linkend="FORCECREATEMODE">
3259 <parameter>force create mode</parameter></link> and <link
3260 linkend="FORCEDIRECTORYMODE"><parameter>force directory mode</parameter>
3261 </link>.</para>
3263 <para>Default: <command>inherit permissions = no</command></para>
3264 </listitem>
3265 </varlistentry>
3269 <varlistentry>
3270 <term><anchor id="INTERFACES">interfaces (G)</term>
3271 <listitem><para>This option allows you to override the default
3272 network interfaces list that Samba will use for browsing, name
3273 registration and other NBT traffic. By default Samba will query
3274 the kernel for the list of all active interfaces and use any
3275 interfaces except 127.0.0.1 that are broadcast capable.</para>
3277 <para>The option takes a list of interface strings. Each string
3278 can be in any of the following forms:</para>
3280 <itemizedlist>
3281 <listitem><para>a network interface name (such as eth0).
3282 This may include shell-like wildcards so eth* will match
3283 any interface starting with the substring "eth"</para></listitem>
3285 <listitem><para>an IP address. In this case the netmask is
3286 determined from the list of interfaces obtained from the
3287 kernel</para></listitem>
3289 <listitem><para>an IP/mask pair. </para></listitem>
3291 <listitem><para>a broadcast/mask pair.</para></listitem>
3292 </itemizedlist>
3294 <para>The "mask" parameters can either be a bit length (such
3295 as 24 for a C class network) or a full netmask in dotted
3296 decimal form.</para>
3298 <para>The "IP" parameters above can either be a full dotted
3299 decimal IP address or a hostname which will be looked up via
3300 the OS's normal hostname resolution mechanisms.</para>
3302 <para>For example, the following line:</para>
3304 <para><command>interfaces = eth0 192.168.2.10/24 192.168.3.10/255.255.255.0
3305 </command></para>
3307 <para>would configure three network interfaces corresponding
3308 to the eth0 device and IP addresses 192.168.2.10 and 192.168.3.10.
3309 The netmasks of the latter two interfaces would be set to 255.255.255.0.</para>
3311 <para>See also <link linkend="BINDINTERFACESONLY"><parameter>bind
3312 interfaces only</parameter></link>.</para>
3314 <para>Default: <emphasis>all active interfaces except 127.0.0.1
3315 that are broadcast capable</emphasis></para>
3316 </listitem>
3317 </varlistentry>
3321 <varlistentry>
3322 <term><anchor id="INVALIDUSERS">invalid users (S)</term>
3323 <listitem><para>This is a list of users that should not be allowed
3324 to login to this service. This is really a <emphasis>paranoid</emphasis>
3325 check to absolutely ensure an improper setting does not breach
3326 your security.</para>
3328 <para>A name starting with a '@' is interpreted as an NIS
3329 netgroup first (if your system supports NIS), and then as a UNIX
3330 group if the name was not found in the NIS netgroup database.</para>
3332 <para>A name starting with '+' is interpreted only
3333 by looking in the UNIX group database. A name starting with
3334 '&' is interpreted only by looking in the NIS netgroup database
3335 (this requires NIS to be working on your system). The characters
3336 '+' and '&' may be used at the start of the name in either order
3337 so the value <parameter>+&amp;group</parameter> means check the
3338 UNIX group database, followed by the NIS netgroup database, and
3339 the value <parameter>&+group</parameter> means check the NIS
3340 netgroup database, followed by the UNIX group database (the
3341 same as the '@' prefix).</para>
3343 <para>The current servicename is substituted for <parameter>%S</parameter>.
3344 This is useful in the [homes] section.</para>
3346 <para>See also <link linkend="VALIDUSERS"><parameter>valid users
3347 </parameter></link>.</para>
3349 <para>Default: <emphasis>no invalid users</emphasis></para>
3350 <para>Example: <command>invalid users = root fred admin @wheel
3351 </command></para>
3352 </listitem>
3353 </varlistentry>
3357 <varlistentry>
3358 <term><anchor id="KEEPALIVE">keepalive (G)</term>
3359 <listitem><para>The value of the parameter (an integer) represents
3360 the number of seconds between <parameter>keepalive</parameter>
3361 packets. If this parameter is zero, no keepalive packets will be
3362 sent. Keepalive packets, if sent, allow the server to tell whether
3363 a client is still present and responding.</para>
3365 <para>Keepalives should, in general, not be needed if the socket
3366 being used has the SO_KEEPALIVE attribute set on it (see <link
3367 linkend="SOCKETOPTIONS"><parameter>socket options</parameter></link>).
3368 Basically you should only use this option if you strike difficulties.</para>
3370 <para>Default: <command>keepalive = 300</command></para>
3371 <para>Example: <command>keepalive = 600</command></para>
3372 </listitem>
3373 </varlistentry>
3377 <varlistentry>
3378 <term><anchor id="KERNELOPLOCKS">kernel oplocks (G)</term>
3379 <listitem><para>For UNIXes that support kernel based <link
3380 linkend="OPLOCKS"><parameter>oplocks</parameter></link>
3381 (currently only IRIX and the Linux 2.4 kernel), this parameter
3382 allows the use of them to be turned on or off.</para>
3384 <para>Kernel oplocks support allows Samba <parameter>oplocks
3385 </parameter> to be broken whenever a local UNIX process or NFS operation
3386 accesses a file that <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command>
3387 </ulink> has oplocked. This allows complete data consistency between
3388 SMB/CIFS, NFS and local file access (and is a <emphasis>very</emphasis>
3389 cool feature :-).</para>
3391 <para>This parameter defaults to <constant>on</constant>, but is translated
3392 to a no-op on systems that no not have the necessary kernel support.
3393 You should never need to touch this parameter.</para>
3395 <para>See also the <link linkend="OPLOCKS"><parameter>oplocks</parameter>
3396 </link> and <link linkend="LEVEL2OPLOCKS"><parameter>level2 oplocks
3397 </parameter></link> parameters.</para>
3399 <para>Default: <command>kernel oplocks = yes</command></para>
3400 </listitem>
3401 </varlistentry>
3406 <varlistentry>
3407 <term><anchor id="LANMANAUTH">lanman auth (G)</term>
3408 <listitem><para>This parameter determines whether or not <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> will
3409 attempt to authenticate users using the LANMAN password hash.
3410 If disabled, only clients which support NT password hashes (e.g. Windows
3411 NT/2000 clients, smbclient, etc... but not Windows 95/98 or the MS DOS
3412 network client) will be able to connect to the Samba host.</para>
3414 <para>Default : <command>lanman auth = yes</command></para>
3415 </listitem>
3416 </varlistentry>
3422 <varlistentry>
3423 <term><anchor id="LARGEREADWRITE">large readwrite (G)</term>
3424 <listitem><para>This parameter determines whether or not <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink>
3425 supports the new 64k streaming read and write varient SMB requests introduced
3426 with Windows 2000. Note that due to Windows 2000 client redirector bugs
3427 this requires Samba to be running on a 64-bit capable operating system such
3428 as IRIX, Solaris or a Linux 2.4 kernel. Can improve performance by 10% with
3429 Windows 2000 clients. Defaults to off. Not as tested as some other Samba
3430 code paths.
3431 </para>
3433 <para>Default : <command>large readwrite = no</command></para>
3434 </listitem>
3435 </varlistentry>
3439 <varlistentry>
3440 <term><anchor id="LDAPADMINDN">ldap admin dn (G)</term>
3441 <listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has been
3442 configure to include the <command>--with-ldapsam</command> option
3443 at compile time. This option should be considered experimental and
3444 under active development.
3445 </para>
3447 <para>
3448 The <parameter>ldap admin dn</parameter> defines the Distinguished
3449 Name (DN) name used by Samba to contact the <link linkend="LDAPSERVER">ldap
3450 server</link> when retreiving user account information. The <parameter>ldap
3451 admin dn</parameter> is used in conjunction with the admin dn password
3452 stored in the <filename>private/secrets.tdb</filename> file. See the
3453 <ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink> man
3454 page for more information on how to accmplish this.
3455 </para>
3458 <para>Default : <emphasis>none</emphasis></para>
3459 </listitem>
3460 </varlistentry>
3465 <varlistentry>
3466 <term><anchor id="LDAPFILTER">ldap filter (G)</term>
3467 <listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has been
3468 configure to include the <command>--with-ldapsam</command> option
3469 at compile time. This option should be considered experimental and
3470 under active development.
3471 </para>
3473 <para>
3474 This parameter specifies the RFC 2254 compliant LDAP search filter.
3475 The default is to match the login name with the <constant>uid</constant>
3476 attribute for all entries matching the <constant>sambaAccount</constant>
3477 objectclass. Note that this filter should only return one entry.
3478 </para>
3481 <para>Default : <command>ldap filter = (&(uid=%u)(objectclass=sambaAccount))</command></para>
3482 </listitem>
3483 </varlistentry>
3488 <varlistentry>
3489 <term><anchor id="LDAPPORT">ldap port (G)</term>
3490 <listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has been
3491 configure to include the <command>--with-ldapsam</command> option
3492 at compile time. This option should be considered experimental and
3493 under active development.
3494 </para>
3496 <para>
3497 This option is used to control the tcp port number used to contact
3498 the <link linkend="LDAPSERVER"><parameter>ldap server</parameter></link>.
3499 The default is to use the stand LDAPS port 636.
3500 </para>
3502 <para>See Also: <link linkend="LDAPSSL">ldap ssl</link>
3503 </para>
3505 <para>Default : <command>ldap port = 636</command></para>
3506 </listitem>
3507 </varlistentry>
3512 <varlistentry>
3513 <term><anchor id="LDAPSERVER">ldap server (G)</term>
3514 <listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has been
3515 configure to include the <command>--with-ldapsam</command> option
3516 at compile time. This option should be considered experimental and
3517 under active development.
3518 </para>
3520 <para>
3521 This parameter should contains the FQDN of the ldap directory
3522 server which should be queried to locate user account information.
3523 </para>
3527 <para>Default : <command>ldap server = localhost</command></para>
3528 </listitem>
3529 </varlistentry>
3534 <varlistentry>
3535 <term><anchor id="LDAPSSL">ldap ssl (G)</term>
3536 <listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has been
3537 configure to include the <command>--with-ldapsam</command> option
3538 at compile time. This option should be considered experimental and
3539 under active development.
3540 </para>
3542 <para>
3543 This option is used to define whether or not Samba should
3544 use SSL when connecting to the <link linkend="LDAPSERVER"><parameter>ldap
3545 server</parameter></link>. This is <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> related to
3546 Samba SSL support which is enabled by specifying the
3547 <command>--with-ssl</command> option to the <filename>configure</filename>
3548 script (see <link linkend="SSL"><parameter>ssl</parameter></link>).
3549 </para>
3551 <para>
3552 The <parameter>ldap ssl</parameter> can be set to one of three values:
3553 (a) <constant>on</constant> - Always use SSL when contacting the
3554 <parameter>ldap server</parameter>, (b) <constant>off</constant> -
3555 Never use SSL when querying the directory, or (c) <constant>start_tls</constant>
3556 - Use the LDAPv3 StartTLS extended operation
3557 (RFC2830) for communicating with the directory server.
3558 </para>
3561 <para>Default : <command>ldap ssl = on</command></para>
3562 </listitem>
3563 </varlistentry>
3568 <varlistentry>
3569 <term><anchor id="LDAPSUFFIX">ldap suffix (G)</term>
3570 <listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has been
3571 configure to include the <command>--with-ldapsam</command> option
3572 at compile time. This option should be considered experimental and
3573 under active development.
3574 </para>
3578 <para>Default : <emphasis>none</emphasis></para>
3579 </listitem>
3580 </varlistentry>
3588 <varlistentry>
3589 <term><anchor id="LEVEL2OPLOCKS">level2 oplocks (S)</term>
3590 <listitem><para>This parameter controls whether Samba supports
3591 level2 (read-only) oplocks on a share.</para>
3593 <para>Level2, or read-only oplocks allow Windows NT clients
3594 that have an oplock on a file to downgrade from a read-write oplock
3595 to a read-only oplock once a second client opens the file (instead
3596 of releasing all oplocks on a second open, as in traditional,
3597 exclusive oplocks). This allows all openers of the file that
3598 support level2 oplocks to cache the file for read-ahead only (ie.
3599 they may not cache writes or lock requests) and increases performance
3600 for many accesses of files that are not commonly written (such as
3601 application .EXE files).</para>
3603 <para>Once one of the clients which have a read-only oplock
3604 writes to the file all clients are notified (no reply is needed
3605 or waited for) and told to break their oplocks to "none" and
3606 delete any read-ahead caches.</para>
3608 <para>It is recommended that this parameter be turned on
3609 to speed access to shared executables.</para>
3611 <para>For more discussions on level2 oplocks see the CIFS spec.</para>
3613 <para>Currently, if <link linkend="KERNELOPLOCKS"><parameter>kernel
3614 oplocks</parameter></link> are supported then level2 oplocks are
3615 not granted (even if this parameter is set to <constant>yes</constant>).
3616 Note also, the <link linkend="OPLOCKS"><parameter>oplocks</parameter>
3617 </link> parameter must be set to <constant>true</constant> on this share in order for
3618 this parameter to have any effect.</para>
3620 <para>See also the <link linkend="OPLOCKS"><parameter>oplocks</parameter>
3621 </link> and <link linkend="OPLOCKS"><parameter>kernel oplocks</parameter>
3622 </link> parameters.</para>
3624 <para>Default: <command>level2 oplocks = yes</command></para>
3625 </listitem>
3626 </varlistentry>
3632 <varlistentry>
3633 <term><anchor id="LMANNOUNCE">lm announce (G)</term>
3634 <listitem><para>This parameter determines if <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">
3635 <command>nmbd(8)</command></ulink> will produce Lanman announce
3636 broadcasts that are needed by OS/2 clients in order for them to see
3637 the Samba server in their browse list. This parameter can have three
3638 values, <constant>true</constant>, <constant>false</constant>, or
3639 <constant>auto</constant>. The default is <constant>auto</constant>.
3640 If set to <constant>false</constant> Samba will never produce these
3641 broadcasts. If set to <constant>true</constant> Samba will produce
3642 Lanman announce broadcasts at a frequency set by the parameter
3643 <parameter>lm interval</parameter>. If set to <constant>auto</constant>
3644 Samba will not send Lanman announce broadcasts by default but will
3645 listen for them. If it hears such a broadcast on the wire it will
3646 then start sending them at a frequency set by the parameter
3647 <parameter>lm interval</parameter>.</para>
3649 <para>See also <link linkend="LMINTERVAL"><parameter>lm interval
3650 </parameter></link>.</para>
3652 <para>Default: <command>lm announce = auto</command></para>
3653 <para>Example: <command>lm announce = yes</command></para>
3654 </listitem>
3655 </varlistentry>
3659 <varlistentry>
3660 <term><anchor id="LMINTERVAL">lm interval (G)</term>
3661 <listitem><para>If Samba is set to produce Lanman announce
3662 broadcasts needed by OS/2 clients (see the <link linkend="LMANNOUNCE">
3663 <parameter>lm announce</parameter></link> parameter) then this
3664 parameter defines the frequency in seconds with which they will be
3665 made. If this is set to zero then no Lanman announcements will be
3666 made despite the setting of the <parameter>lm announce</parameter>
3667 parameter.</para>
3669 <para>See also <link linkend="LMANNOUNCE"><parameter>lm
3670 announce</parameter></link>.</para>
3672 <para>Default: <command>lm interval = 60</command></para>
3673 <para>Example: <command>lm interval = 120</command></para>
3674 </listitem>
3675 </varlistentry>
3679 <varlistentry>
3680 <term><anchor id="LOADPRINTERS">load printers (G)</term>
3681 <listitem><para>A boolean variable that controls whether all
3682 printers in the printcap will be loaded for browsing by default.
3683 See the <link linkend="PRINTERSSECT">printers</link> section for
3684 more details.</para>
3686 <para>Default: <command>load printers = yes</command></para></listitem>
3687 </varlistentry>
3692 <varlistentry>
3693 <term><anchor id="LOCALMASTER">local master (G)</term>
3694 <listitem><para>This option allows <ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command>
3695 nmbd(8)</command></ulink> to try and become a local master browser
3696 on a subnet. If set to <constant>false</constant> then <command>
3697 nmbd</command> will not attempt to become a local master browser
3698 on a subnet and will also lose in all browsing elections. By
3699 default this value is set to <constant>true</constant>. Setting this value to <constant>true</constant> doesn't
3700 mean that Samba will <emphasis>become</emphasis> the local master
3701 browser on a subnet, just that <command>nmbd</command> will <emphasis>
3702 participate</emphasis> in elections for local master browser.</para>
3704 <para>Setting this value to <constant>false</constant> will cause <command>nmbd</command>
3705 <emphasis>never</emphasis> to become a local master browser.</para>
3707 <para>Default: <command>local master = yes</command></para>
3708 </listitem>
3709 </varlistentry>
3713 <varlistentry>
3714 <term><anchor id="LOCKDIR">lock dir (G)</term>
3715 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="LOCKDIRECTORY"><parameter>
3716 lock directory</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
3717 </varlistentry>
3721 <varlistentry>
3722 <term><anchor id="LOCKDIRECTORY">lock directory (G)</term>
3723 <listitem><para>This option specifies the directory where lock
3724 files will be placed. The lock files are used to implement the
3725 <link linkend="MAXCONNECTIONS"><parameter>max connections</parameter>
3726 </link> option.</para>
3728 <para>Default: <command>lock directory = ${prefix}/var/locks</command></para>
3729 <para>Example: <command>lock directory = /var/run/samba/locks</command>
3730 </para></listitem>
3731 </varlistentry>
3735 <varlistentry>
3736 <term><anchor id="LOCKSPINCOUNT">lock spin count (G)</term>
3737 <listitem><para>This parameter controls the number of times
3738 that smbd should attempt to gain a byte range lock on the
3739 behalf of a client request. Experiments have shown that
3740 Windows 2k servers do not reply with a failure if the lock
3741 could not be immediately granted, but try a few more times
3742 in case the lock could later be aquired. This behavior
3743 is used to support PC database formats such as MS Access
3744 and FoxPro.
3745 </para>
3747 <para>Default: <command>lock spin count = 2</command>
3748 </para></listitem>
3749 </varlistentry>
3754 <varlistentry>
3755 <term><anchor id="LOCKSPINTIME">lock spin time (G)</term>
3756 <listitem><para>The time in microseconds that smbd should
3757 pause before attempting to gain a failed lock. See
3758 <link linkend="LOCKSPINCOUNT"><parameter>lock spin
3759 count</parameter></link> for more details.
3760 </para>
3762 <para>Default: <command>lock spin time = 10</command>
3763 </para></listitem>
3764 </varlistentry>
3768 <varlistentry>
3769 <term><anchor id="LOCKING">locking (S)</term>
3770 <listitem><para>This controls whether or not locking will be
3771 performed by the server in response to lock requests from the
3772 client.</para>
3774 <para>If <command>locking = no</command>, all lock and unlock
3775 requests will appear to succeed and all lock queries will report
3776 that the file in question is available for locking.</para>
3778 <para>If <command>locking = yes</command>, real locking will be performed
3779 by the server.</para>
3781 <para>This option <emphasis>may</emphasis> be useful for read-only
3782 filesystems which <emphasis>may</emphasis> not need locking (such as
3783 CDROM drives), although setting this parameter of <constant>no</constant>
3784 is not really recommended even in this case.</para>
3786 <para>Be careful about disabling locking either globally or in a
3787 specific service, as lack of locking may result in data corruption.
3788 You should never need to set this parameter.</para>
3790 <para>Default: <command>locking = yes</command></para>
3791 </listitem>
3792 </varlistentry>
3796 <varlistentry>
3797 <term><anchor id="LOGFILE">log file (G)</term>
3798 <listitem><para>This option allows you to override the name
3799 of the Samba log file (also known as the debug file).</para>
3801 <para>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing
3802 you to have separate log files for each user or machine.</para>
3804 <para>Example: <command>log file = /usr/local/samba/var/log.%m
3805 </command></para></listitem>
3806 </varlistentry>
3810 <varlistentry>
3811 <term><anchor id="LOGLEVEL">log level (G)</term>
3812 <listitem><para>The value of the parameter (an integer) allows
3813 the debug level (logging level) to be specified in the
3814 <filename>smb.conf</filename> file. This is to give greater
3815 flexibility in the configuration of the system.</para>
3817 <para>The default will be the log level specified on
3818 the command line or level zero if none was specified.</para>
3820 <para>Example: <command>log level = 3</command></para></listitem>
3821 </varlistentry>
3825 <varlistentry>
3826 <term><anchor id="LOGONDRIVE">logon drive (G)</term>
3827 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the local path to
3828 which the home directory will be connected (see <link
3829 linkend="LOGONHOME"><parameter>logon home</parameter></link>)
3830 and is only used by NT Workstations. </para>
3832 <para>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up as a
3833 logon server.</para>
3835 <para>Default: <command>logon drive = z:</command></para>
3836 <para>Example: <command>logon drive = h:</command></para>
3837 </listitem>
3838 </varlistentry>
3842 <varlistentry>
3843 <term><anchor id="LOGONHOME">logon home (G)</term>
3844 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the home directory
3845 location when a Win95/98 or NT Workstation logs into a Samba PDC.
3846 It allows you to do </para>
3848 <para><prompt>C:\> </prompt><userinput>NET USE H: /HOME</userinput>
3849 </para>
3851 <para>from a command prompt, for example.</para>
3853 <para>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing
3854 you to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine.</para>
3856 <para>This parameter can be used with Win9X workstations to ensure
3857 that roaming profiles are stored in a subdirectory of the user's
3858 home directory. This is done in the following way:</para>
3860 <para><command>logon home = \\%N\%U\profile</command></para>
3862 <para>This tells Samba to return the above string, with
3863 substitutions made when a client requests the info, generally
3864 in a NetUserGetInfo request. Win9X clients truncate the info to
3865 \\server\share when a user does <command>net use /home</command>
3866 but use the whole string when dealing with profiles.</para>
3868 <para>Note that in prior versions of Samba, the <link linkend="LOGONPATH">
3869 <parameter>logon path</parameter></link> was returned rather than
3870 <parameter>logon home</parameter>. This broke <command>net use
3871 /home</command> but allowed profiles outside the home directory.
3872 The current implementation is correct, and can be used for
3873 profiles if you use the above trick.</para>
3875 <para>This option is only useful if Samba is set up as a logon
3876 server.</para>
3878 <para>Default: <command>logon home = "\\%N\%U"</command></para>
3879 <para>Example: <command>logon home = "\\remote_smb_server\%U"</command>
3880 </para></listitem>
3881 </varlistentry>
3884 <varlistentry>
3885 <term><anchor id="LOGONPATH">logon path (G)</term>
3886 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the home directory
3887 where roaming profiles (NTuser.dat etc files for Windows NT) are
3888 stored. Contrary to previous versions of these manual pages, it has
3889 nothing to do with Win 9X roaming profiles. To find out how to
3890 handle roaming profiles for Win 9X system, see the <link linkend="LOGONHOME">
3891 <parameter>logon home</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
3893 <para>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you
3894 to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine. It also
3895 specifies the directory from which the "Application Data",
3896 (<filename>desktop</filename>, <filename>start menu</filename>,
3897 <filename>network neighborhood</filename>, <filename>programs</filename>
3898 and other folders, and their contents, are loaded and displayed on
3899 your Windows NT client.</para>
3901 <para>The share and the path must be readable by the user for
3902 the preferences and directories to be loaded onto the Windows NT
3903 client. The share must be writeable when the user logs in for the first
3904 time, in order that the Windows NT client can create the NTuser.dat
3905 and other directories.</para>
3907 <para>Thereafter, the directories and any of the contents can,
3908 if required, be made read-only. It is not advisable that the
3909 NTuser.dat file be made read-only - rename it to NTuser.man to
3910 achieve the desired effect (a <emphasis>MAN</emphasis>datory
3911 profile). </para>
3913 <para>Windows clients can sometimes maintain a connection to
3914 the [homes] share, even though there is no user logged in.
3915 Therefore, it is vital that the logon path does not include a
3916 reference to the homes share (i.e. setting this parameter to
3917 \%N\%U\profile_path will cause problems).</para>
3919 <para>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing
3920 you to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine.</para>
3922 <para>Note that this option is only useful if Samba is set up
3923 as a logon server.</para>
3925 <para>Default: <command>logon path = \\%N\%U\profile</command></para>
3926 <para>Example: <command>logon path = \\PROFILESERVER\PROFILE\%U</command></para>
3927 </listitem>
3928 </varlistentry>
3932 <varlistentry>
3933 <term><anchor id="LOGONSCRIPT">logon script (G)</term>
3934 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the batch file (.bat) or
3935 NT command file (.cmd) to be downloaded and run on a machine when
3936 a user successfully logs in. The file must contain the DOS
3937 style CR/LF line endings. Using a DOS-style editor to create the
3938 file is recommended.</para>
3940 <para>The script must be a relative path to the [netlogon]
3941 service. If the [netlogon] service specifies a <link linkend="PATH">
3942 <parameter>path</parameter></link> of <filename>/usr/local/samba/netlogon
3943 </filename>, and <command>logon script = STARTUP.BAT</command>, then
3944 the file that will be downloaded is:</para>
3946 <para><filename>/usr/local/samba/netlogon/STARTUP.BAT</filename></para>
3948 <para>The contents of the batch file are entirely your choice. A
3949 suggested command would be to add <command>NET TIME \\SERVER /SET
3950 /YES</command>, to force every machine to synchronize clocks with
3951 the same time server. Another use would be to add <command>NET USE
3952 U: \\SERVER\UTILS</command> for commonly used utilities, or <command>
3953 NET USE Q: \\SERVER\ISO9001_QA</command> for example.</para>
3955 <para>Note that it is particularly important not to allow write
3956 access to the [netlogon] share, or to grant users write permission
3957 on the batch files in a secure environment, as this would allow
3958 the batch files to be arbitrarily modified and security to be
3959 breached.</para>
3961 <para>This option takes the standard substitutions, allowing you
3962 to have separate logon scripts for each user or machine.</para>
3964 <para>This option is only useful if Samba is set up as a logon
3965 server.</para>
3967 <para>Default: <emphasis>no logon script defined</emphasis></para>
3968 <para>Example: <command>logon script = scripts\%U.bat</command></para>
3969 </listitem>
3970 </varlistentry>
3974 <varlistentry>
3975 <term><anchor id="LPPAUSECOMMAND">lppause command (S)</term>
3976 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be
3977 executed on the server host in order to stop printing or spooling
3978 a specific print job.</para>
3980 <para>This command should be a program or script which takes
3981 a printer name and job number to pause the print job. One way
3982 of implementing this is by using job priorities, where jobs
3983 having a too low priority won't be sent to the printer.</para>
3985 <para>If a <parameter>%p</parameter> is given then the printer name
3986 is put in its place. A <parameter>%j</parameter> is replaced with
3987 the job number (an integer). On HPUX (see <parameter>printing=hpux
3988 </parameter>), if the <parameter>-p%p</parameter> option is added
3989 to the lpq command, the job will show up with the correct status, i.e.
3990 if the job priority is lower than the set fence priority it will
3991 have the PAUSED status, whereas if the priority is equal or higher it
3992 will have the SPOOLED or PRINTING status.</para>
3994 <para>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path
3995 in the lppause command as the PATH may not be available to the server.</para>
3997 <para>See also the <link linkend="PRINTING"><parameter>printing
3998 </parameter></link> parameter.</para>
4000 <para>Default: Currently no default value is given to
4001 this string, unless the value of the <parameter>printing</parameter>
4002 parameter is <constant>SYSV</constant>, in which case the default is :</para>
4004 <para><command>lp -i %p-%j -H hold</command></para>
4006 <para>or if the value of the <parameter>printing</parameter> parameter
4007 is <constant>SOFTQ</constant>, then the default is:</para>
4009 <para><command>qstat -s -j%j -h</command></para>
4011 <para>Example for HPUX: <command>lppause command = /usr/bin/lpalt
4012 %p-%j -p0</command></para>
4013 </listitem>
4014 </varlistentry>
4018 <varlistentry>
4019 <term><anchor id="LPQCACHETIME">lpq cache time (G)</term>
4020 <listitem><para>This controls how long lpq info will be cached
4021 for to prevent the <command>lpq</command> command being called too
4022 often. A separate cache is kept for each variation of the <command>
4023 lpq</command> command used by the system, so if you use different
4024 <command>lpq</command> commands for different users then they won't
4025 share cache information.</para>
4027 <para>The cache files are stored in <filename>/tmp/lpq.xxxx</filename>
4028 where xxxx is a hash of the <command>lpq</command> command in use.</para>
4030 <para>The default is 10 seconds, meaning that the cached results
4031 of a previous identical <command>lpq</command> command will be used
4032 if the cached data is less than 10 seconds old. A large value may
4033 be advisable if your <command>lpq</command> command is very slow.</para>
4035 <para>A value of 0 will disable caching completely.</para>
4037 <para>See also the <link linkend="PRINTING"><parameter>printing
4038 </parameter></link> parameter.</para>
4040 <para>Default: <command>lpq cache time = 10</command></para>
4041 <para>Example: <command>lpq cache time = 30</command></para>
4042 </listitem>
4043 </varlistentry>
4047 <varlistentry>
4048 <term><anchor id="LPQCOMMAND">lpq command (S)</term>
4049 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be
4050 executed on the server host in order to obtain <command>lpq
4051 </command>-style printer status information.</para>
4053 <para>This command should be a program or script which
4054 takes a printer name as its only parameter and outputs printer
4055 status information.</para>
4057 <para>Currently nine styles of printer status information
4058 are supported; BSD, AIX, LPRNG, PLP, SYSV, HPUX, QNX, CUPS, and SOFTQ.
4059 This covers most UNIX systems. You control which type is expected
4060 using the <parameter>printing =</parameter> option.</para>
4062 <para>Some clients (notably Windows for Workgroups) may not
4063 correctly send the connection number for the printer they are
4064 requesting status information about. To get around this, the
4065 server reports on the first printer service connected to by the
4066 client. This only happens if the connection number sent is invalid.</para>
4068 <para>If a <parameter>%p</parameter> is given then the printer name
4069 is put in its place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the
4070 command.</para>
4072 <para>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path
4073 in the <parameter>lpq command</parameter> as the <envar>$PATH
4074 </envar> may not be available to the server. When compiled with
4075 the CUPS libraries, no <parameter>lpq command</parameter> is
4076 needed because smbd will make a library call to obtain the
4077 print queue listing.</para>
4079 <para>See also the <link linkend="PRINTING"><parameter>printing
4080 </parameter></link> parameter.</para>
4082 <para>Default: <emphasis>depends on the setting of <parameter>
4083 printing</parameter></emphasis></para>
4085 <para>Example: <command>lpq command = /usr/bin/lpq -P%p</command></para>
4086 </listitem>
4087 </varlistentry>
4091 <varlistentry>
4092 <term><anchor id="LPRESUMECOMMAND">lpresume command (S)</term>
4093 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be
4094 executed on the server host in order to restart or continue
4095 printing or spooling a specific print job.</para>
4097 <para>This command should be a program or script which takes
4098 a printer name and job number to resume the print job. See
4099 also the <link linkend="LPPAUSECOMMAND"><parameter>lppause command
4100 </parameter></link> parameter.</para>
4102 <para>If a <parameter>%p</parameter> is given then the printer name
4103 is put in its place. A <parameter>%j</parameter> is replaced with
4104 the job number (an integer).</para>
4106 <para>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute path
4107 in the <parameter>lpresume command</parameter> as the PATH may not
4108 be available to the server.</para>
4110 <para>See also the <link linkend="PRINTING"><parameter>printing
4111 </parameter></link> parameter.</para>
4113 <para>Default: Currently no default value is given
4114 to this string, unless the value of the <parameter>printing</parameter>
4115 parameter is <constant>SYSV</constant>, in which case the default is :</para>
4117 <para><command>lp -i %p-%j -H resume</command></para>
4119 <para>or if the value of the <parameter>printing</parameter> parameter
4120 is <constant>SOFTQ</constant>, then the default is:</para>
4122 <para><command>qstat -s -j%j -r</command></para>
4124 <para>Example for HPUX: <command>lpresume command = /usr/bin/lpalt
4125 %p-%j -p2</command></para>
4126 </listitem>
4127 </varlistentry>
4131 <varlistentry>
4132 <term><anchor id="LPRMCOMMAND">lprm command (S)</term>
4133 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be
4134 executed on the server host in order to delete a print job.</para>
4136 <para>This command should be a program or script which takes
4137 a printer name and job number, and deletes the print job.</para>
4139 <para>If a <parameter>%p</parameter> is given then the printer name
4140 is put in its place. A <parameter>%j</parameter> is replaced with
4141 the job number (an integer).</para>
4143 <para>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute
4144 path in the <parameter>lprm command</parameter> as the PATH may not be
4145 available to the server.</para>
4147 <para>See also the <link linkend="PRINTING"><parameter>printing
4148 </parameter></link> parameter.</para>
4150 <para>Default: <emphasis>depends on the setting of <parameter>printing
4151 </parameter></emphasis></para>
4153 <para>Example 1: <command>lprm command = /usr/bin/lprm -P%p %j
4154 </command></para>
4155 <para>Example 2: <command>lprm command = /usr/bin/cancel %p-%j
4156 </command></para></listitem>
4157 </varlistentry>
4161 <varlistentry>
4162 <term><anchor id="MACHINEPASSWORDTIMEOUT">machine password timeout (G)</term>
4163 <listitem><para>If a Samba server is a member of a Windows
4164 NT Domain (see the <link linkend="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN">security = domain</link>)
4165 parameter) then periodically a running <ulink url="smbd.8.html">
4166 smbd(8)</ulink> process will try and change the MACHINE ACCOUNT
4167 PASSWORD stored in the TDB called <filename>private/secrets.tdb
4168 </filename>. This parameter specifies how often this password
4169 will be changed, in seconds. The default is one week (expressed in
4170 seconds), the same as a Windows NT Domain member server.</para>
4172 <para>See also <ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>smbpasswd(8)
4173 </command></ulink>, and the <link linkend="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN">
4174 security = domain</link>) parameter.</para>
4176 <para>Default: <command>machine password timeout = 604800</command></para>
4177 </listitem>
4178 </varlistentry>
4181 <varlistentry>
4182 <term><anchor id="MAGICOUTPUT">magic output (S)</term>
4183 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the name of a file
4184 which will contain output created by a magic script (see the
4185 <link linkend="MAGICSCRIPT"><parameter>magic script</parameter></link>
4186 parameter below).</para>
4188 <para>Warning: If two clients use the same <parameter>magic script
4189 </parameter> in the same directory the output file content
4190 is undefined.</para>
4192 <para>Default: <command>magic output = &lt;magic script name&gt;.out
4193 </command></para>
4195 <para>Example: <command>magic output = myfile.txt</command></para>
4196 </listitem>
4197 </varlistentry>
4201 <varlistentry>
4202 <term><anchor id="MAGICSCRIPT">magic script (S)</term>
4203 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the name of a file which,
4204 if opened, will be executed by the server when the file is closed.
4205 This allows a UNIX script to be sent to the Samba host and
4206 executed on behalf of the connected user.</para>
4208 <para>Scripts executed in this way will be deleted upon
4209 completion assuming that the user has the appropriate level
4210 of privilege and the file permissions allow the deletion.</para>
4212 <para>If the script generates output, output will be sent to
4213 the file specified by the <link linkend="MAGICOUTPUT"><parameter>
4214 magic output</parameter></link> parameter (see above).</para>
4216 <para>Note that some shells are unable to interpret scripts
4217 containing CR/LF instead of CR as
4218 the end-of-line marker. Magic scripts must be executable
4219 <emphasis>as is</emphasis> on the host, which for some hosts and
4220 some shells will require filtering at the DOS end.</para>
4222 <para>Magic scripts are <emphasis>EXPERIMENTAL</emphasis> and
4223 should <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> be relied upon.</para>
4225 <para>Default: <emphasis>None. Magic scripts disabled.</emphasis></para>
4226 <para>Example: <command>magic script = user.csh</command></para>
4227 </listitem>
4228 </varlistentry>
4232 <varlistentry>
4233 <term><anchor id="MANGLECASE">mangle case (S)</term>
4234 <listitem><para>See the section on <link linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">
4235 NAME MANGLING</link></para>
4237 <para>Default: <command>mangle case = no</command></para>
4238 </listitem>
4239 </varlistentry>
4242 <varlistentry>
4243 <term><anchor id="MANGLEDMAP">mangled map (S)</term>
4244 <listitem><para>This is for those who want to directly map UNIX
4245 file names which cannot be represented on Windows/DOS. The mangling
4246 of names is not always what is needed. In particular you may have
4247 documents with file extensions that differ between DOS and UNIX.
4248 For example, under UNIX it is common to use <filename>.html</filename>
4249 for HTML files, whereas under Windows/DOS <filename>.htm</filename>
4250 is more commonly used.</para>
4252 <para>So to map <filename>html</filename> to <filename>htm</filename>
4253 you would use:</para>
4255 <para><command>mangled map = (*.html *.htm)</command></para>
4257 <para>One very useful case is to remove the annoying <filename>;1
4258 </filename> off the ends of filenames on some CDROMs (only visible
4259 under some UNIXes). To do this use a map of (*;1 *;).</para>
4261 <para>Default: <emphasis>no mangled map</emphasis></para>
4262 <para>Example: <command>mangled map = (*;1 *;)</command></para>
4263 </listitem>
4264 </varlistentry>
4267 <varlistentry>
4268 <term><anchor id="MANGLEDNAMES">mangled names (S)</term>
4269 <listitem><para>This controls whether non-DOS names under UNIX
4270 should be mapped to DOS-compatible names ("mangled") and made visible,
4271 or whether non-DOS names should simply be ignored.</para>
4273 <para>See the section on <link linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">
4274 NAME MANGLING</link> for details on how to control the mangling process.</para>
4276 <para>If mangling is used then the mangling algorithm is as follows:</para>
4278 <itemizedlist>
4279 <listitem><para>The first (up to) five alphanumeric characters
4280 before the rightmost dot of the filename are preserved, forced
4281 to upper case, and appear as the first (up to) five characters
4282 of the mangled name.</para></listitem>
4284 <listitem><para>A tilde "~" is appended to the first part of the mangled
4285 name, followed by a two-character unique sequence, based on the
4286 original root name (i.e., the original filename minus its final
4287 extension). The final extension is included in the hash calculation
4288 only if it contains any upper case characters or is longer than three
4289 characters.</para>
4291 <para>Note that the character to use may be specified using
4292 the <link linkend="MANGLINGCHAR"><parameter>mangling char</parameter>
4293 </link> option, if you don't like '~'.</para></listitem>
4295 <listitem><para>The first three alphanumeric characters of the final
4296 extension are preserved, forced to upper case and appear as the
4297 extension of the mangled name. The final extension is defined as that
4298 part of the original filename after the rightmost dot. If there are no
4299 dots in the filename, the mangled name will have no extension (except
4300 in the case of "hidden files" - see below).</para></listitem>
4302 <listitem><para>Files whose UNIX name begins with a dot will be
4303 presented as DOS hidden files. The mangled name will be created as
4304 for other filenames, but with the leading dot removed and "___" as
4305 its extension regardless of actual original extension (that's three
4306 underscores).</para></listitem>
4307 </itemizedlist>
4309 <para>The two-digit hash value consists of upper case
4310 alphanumeric characters.</para>
4312 <para>This algorithm can cause name collisions only if files
4313 in a directory share the same first five alphanumeric characters.
4314 The probability of such a clash is 1/1300.</para>
4316 <para>The name mangling (if enabled) allows a file to be
4317 copied between UNIX directories from Windows/DOS while retaining
4318 the long UNIX filename. UNIX files can be renamed to a new extension
4319 from Windows/DOS and will retain the same basename. Mangled names
4320 do not change between sessions.</para>
4322 <para>Default: <command>mangled names = yes</command></para>
4323 </listitem>
4324 </varlistentry>
4328 <varlistentry>
4329 <term><anchor id="MANGLEDSTACK">mangled stack (G)</term>
4330 <listitem><para>This parameter controls the number of mangled names
4331 that should be cached in the Samba server <ulink url="smbd.8.html">
4332 smbd(8)</ulink>.</para>
4334 <para>This stack is a list of recently mangled base names
4335 (extensions are only maintained if they are longer than 3 characters
4336 or contains upper case characters).</para>
4338 <para>The larger this value, the more likely it is that mangled
4339 names can be successfully converted to correct long UNIX names.
4340 However, large stack sizes will slow most directory accesses. Smaller
4341 stacks save memory in the server (each stack element costs 256 bytes).
4342 </para>
4344 <para>It is not possible to absolutely guarantee correct long
4345 filenames, so be prepared for some surprises!</para>
4347 <para>Default: <command>mangled stack = 50</command></para>
4348 <para>Example: <command>mangled stack = 100</command></para>
4349 </listitem>
4350 </varlistentry>
4355 <varlistentry>
4356 <term><anchor id="MANGLINGCHAR">mangling char (S)</term>
4357 <listitem><para>This controls what character is used as
4358 the <emphasis>magic</emphasis> character in <link
4359 linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">name mangling</link>. The default is a '~'
4360 but this may interfere with some software. Use this option to set
4361 it to whatever you prefer.</para>
4363 <para>Default: <command>mangling char = ~</command></para>
4364 <para>Example: <command>mangling char = ^</command></para>
4365 </listitem>
4366 </varlistentry>
4372 <varlistentry>
4373 <term><anchor id="MAPARCHIVE">map archive (S)</term>
4374 <listitem><para>This controls whether the DOS archive attribute
4375 should be mapped to the UNIX owner execute bit. The DOS archive bit
4376 is set when a file has been modified since its last backup. One
4377 motivation for this option it to keep Samba/your PC from making
4378 any file it touches from becoming executable under UNIX. This can
4379 be quite annoying for shared source code, documents, etc...</para>
4381 <para>Note that this requires the <parameter>create mask</parameter>
4382 parameter to be set such that owner execute bit is not masked out
4383 (i.e. it must include 100). See the parameter <link linkend="CREATEMASK">
4384 <parameter>create mask</parameter></link> for details.</para>
4386 <para>Default: <command>map archive = yes</command></para>
4387 </listitem>
4388 </varlistentry>
4392 <varlistentry>
4393 <term><anchor id="MAPHIDDEN">map hidden (S)</term>
4394 <listitem><para>This controls whether DOS style hidden files
4395 should be mapped to the UNIX world execute bit.</para>
4397 <para>Note that this requires the <parameter>create mask</parameter>
4398 to be set such that the world execute bit is not masked out (i.e.
4399 it must include 001). See the parameter <link linkend="CREATEMASK">
4400 <parameter>create mask</parameter></link> for details.</para>
4402 <para>Default: <command>map hidden = no</command></para>
4403 </listitem>
4404 </varlistentry>
4407 <varlistentry>
4408 <term><anchor id="MAPSYSTEM">map system (S)</term>
4409 <listitem><para>This controls whether DOS style system files
4410 should be mapped to the UNIX group execute bit.</para>
4412 <para>Note that this requires the <parameter>create mask</parameter>
4413 to be set such that the group execute bit is not masked out (i.e.
4414 it must include 010). See the parameter <link linkend="CREATEMASK">
4415 <parameter>create mask</parameter></link> for details.</para>
4417 <para>Default: <command>map system = no</command></para>
4418 </listitem>
4419 </varlistentry>
4422 <varlistentry>
4423 <term><anchor id="MAPTOGUEST">map to guest (G)</term>
4424 <listitem><para>This parameter is only useful in <link linkend="SECURITY">
4425 security</link> modes other than <parameter>security = share</parameter>
4426 - i.e. <constant>user</constant>, <constant>server</constant>,
4427 and <constant>domain</constant>.</para>
4429 <para>This parameter can take three different values, which tell
4430 <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> what to do with user
4431 login requests that don't match a valid UNIX user in some way.</para>
4433 <para>The three settings are :</para>
4435 <itemizedlist>
4436 <listitem><para><constant>Never</constant> - Means user login
4437 requests with an invalid password are rejected. This is the
4438 default.</para></listitem>
4440 <listitem><para><constant>Bad User</constant> - Means user
4441 logins with an invalid password are rejected, unless the username
4442 does not exist, in which case it is treated as a guest login and
4443 mapped into the <link linkend="GUESTACCOUNT"><parameter>
4444 guest account</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
4446 <listitem><para><constant>Bad Password</constant> - Means user logins
4447 with an invalid password are treated as a guest login and mapped
4448 into the <link linkend="GUESTACCOUNT">guest account</link>. Note that
4449 this can cause problems as it means that any user incorrectly typing
4450 their password will be silently logged on as "guest" - and
4451 will not know the reason they cannot access files they think
4452 they should - there will have been no message given to them
4453 that they got their password wrong. Helpdesk services will
4454 <emphasis>hate</emphasis> you if you set the <parameter>map to
4455 guest</parameter> parameter this way :-).</para></listitem>
4456 </itemizedlist>
4458 <para>Note that this parameter is needed to set up "Guest"
4459 share services when using <parameter>security</parameter> modes other than
4460 share. This is because in these modes the name of the resource being
4461 requested is <emphasis>not</emphasis> sent to the server until after
4462 the server has successfully authenticated the client so the server
4463 cannot make authentication decisions at the correct time (connection
4464 to the share) for "Guest" shares.</para>
4466 <para>For people familiar with the older Samba releases, this
4467 parameter maps to the old compile-time setting of the <constant>
4468 GUEST_SESSSETUP</constant> value in local.h.</para>
4470 <para>Default: <command>map to guest = Never</command></para>
4471 <para>Example: <command>map to guest = Bad User</command></para>
4472 </listitem>
4473 </varlistentry>
4477 <varlistentry>
4478 <term><anchor id="MAXCONNECTIONS">max connections (S)</term>
4479 <listitem><para>This option allows the number of simultaneous
4480 connections to a service to be limited. If <parameter>max connections
4481 </parameter> is greater than 0 then connections will be refused if
4482 this number of connections to the service are already open. A value
4483 of zero mean an unlimited number of connections may be made.</para>
4485 <para>Record lock files are used to implement this feature. The
4486 lock files will be stored in the directory specified by the <link
4487 linkend="LOCKDIRECTORY"><parameter>lock directory</parameter></link>
4488 option.</para>
4490 <para>Default: <command>max connections = 0</command></para>
4491 <para>Example: <command>max connections = 10</command></para>
4492 </listitem>
4493 </varlistentry>
4497 <varlistentry>
4498 <term><anchor id="MAXDISKSIZE">max disk size (G)</term>
4499 <listitem><para>This option allows you to put an upper limit
4500 on the apparent size of disks. If you set this option to 100
4501 then all shares will appear to be not larger than 100 MB in
4502 size.</para>
4504 <para>Note that this option does not limit the amount of
4505 data you can put on the disk. In the above case you could still
4506 store much more than 100 MB on the disk, but if a client ever asks
4507 for the amount of free disk space or the total disk size then the
4508 result will be bounded by the amount specified in <parameter>max
4509 disk size</parameter>.</para>
4511 <para>This option is primarily useful to work around bugs
4512 in some pieces of software that can't handle very large disks,
4513 particularly disks over 1GB in size.</para>
4515 <para>A <parameter>max disk size</parameter> of 0 means no limit.</para>
4517 <para>Default: <command>max disk size = 0</command></para>
4518 <para>Example: <command>max disk size = 1000</command></para>
4519 </listitem>
4520 </varlistentry>
4524 <varlistentry>
4525 <term><anchor id="MAXLOGSIZE">max log size (G)</term>
4526 <listitem><para>This option (an integer in kilobytes) specifies
4527 the max size the log file should grow to. Samba periodically checks
4528 the size and if it is exceeded it will rename the file, adding
4529 a <filename>.old</filename> extension.</para>
4531 <para>A size of 0 means no limit.</para>
4533 <para>Default: <command>max log size = 5000</command></para>
4534 <para>Example: <command>max log size = 1000</command></para>
4535 </listitem>
4536 </varlistentry>
4540 <varlistentry>
4541 <term><anchor id="MAXMUX">max mux (G)</term>
4542 <listitem><para>This option controls the maximum number of
4543 outstanding simultaneous SMB operations that Samba tells the client
4544 it will allow. You should never need to set this parameter.</para>
4546 <para>Default: <command>max mux = 50</command></para>
4547 </listitem>
4548 </varlistentry>
4552 <varlistentry>
4553 <term><anchor id="MAXOPENFILES">max open files (G)</term>
4554 <listitem><para>This parameter limits the maximum number of
4555 open files that one <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> file
4556 serving process may have open for a client at any one time. The
4557 default for this parameter is set very high (10,000) as Samba uses
4558 only one bit per unopened file.</para>
4560 <para>The limit of the number of open files is usually set
4561 by the UNIX per-process file descriptor limit rather than
4562 this parameter so you should never need to touch this parameter.</para>
4564 <para>Default: <command>max open files = 10000</command></para>
4565 </listitem>
4566 </varlistentry>
4570 <varlistentry>
4571 <term><anchor id="MAXPRINTJOBS">max print jobs (S)</term>
4572 <listitem><para>This parameter limits the maximum number of
4573 jobs allowable in a Samba printer queue at any given moment.
4574 If this number is exceeded, <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>
4575 smbd(8)</command></ulink> will remote "Out of Space" to the client.
4576 See all <link linkend="TOTALPRINTJOBS"><parameter>total
4577 print jobs</parameter></link>.
4578 </para>
4580 <para>Default: <command>max print jobs = 1000</command></para>
4581 <para>Example: <command>max print jobs = 5000</command></para>
4582 </listitem>
4583 </varlistentry>
4586 <varlistentry>
4587 <term><anchor id="MAXPROTOCOL">max protocol (G)</term>
4588 <listitem><para>The value of the parameter (a string) is the highest
4589 protocol level that will be supported by the server.</para>
4591 <para>Possible values are :</para>
4592 <itemizedlist>
4593 <listitem><para><constant>CORE</constant>: Earliest version. No
4594 concept of user names.</para></listitem>
4596 <listitem><para><constant>COREPLUS</constant>: Slight improvements on
4597 CORE for efficiency.</para></listitem>
4599 <listitem><para><constant>LANMAN1</constant>: First <emphasis>
4600 modern</emphasis> version of the protocol. Long filename
4601 support.</para></listitem>
4603 <listitem><para><constant>LANMAN2</constant>: Updates to Lanman1 protocol.
4604 </para></listitem>
4606 <listitem><para><constant>NT1</constant>: Current up to date version of
4607 the protocol. Used by Windows NT. Known as CIFS.</para></listitem>
4608 </itemizedlist>
4610 <para>Normally this option should not be set as the automatic
4611 negotiation phase in the SMB protocol takes care of choosing
4612 the appropriate protocol.</para>
4614 <para>See also <link linkend="MINPROTOCOL"><parameter>min
4615 protocol</parameter></link></para>
4617 <para>Default: <command>max protocol = NT1</command></para>
4618 <para>Example: <command>max protocol = LANMAN1</command></para>
4619 </listitem>
4620 </varlistentry>
4624 <varlistentry>
4625 <term><anchor id="MAXSMBDPROCESSES">max smbd processes (G)</term>
4626 <listitem><para>This parameter limits the maximum number of
4627 <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>
4628 processes concurrently running on a system and is intended
4629 as a stopgap to prevent degrading service to clients in the event
4630 that the server has insufficient resources to handle more than this
4631 number of connections. Remember that under normal operating
4632 conditions, each user will have an <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> associated with him or her
4633 to handle connections to all shares from a given host.
4634 </para>
4636 <para>Default: <command>max smbd processes = 0</command> ## no limit</para>
4637 <para>Example: <command>max smbd processes = 1000</command></para>
4638 </listitem>
4639 </varlistentry>
4644 <varlistentry>
4645 <term><anchor id="MAXTTL">max ttl (G)</term>
4646 <listitem><para>This option tells <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink>
4647 what the default 'time to live' of NetBIOS names should be (in seconds)
4648 when <command>nmbd</command> is requesting a name using either a
4649 broadcast packet or from a WINS server. You should never need to
4650 change this parameter. The default is 3 days.</para>
4652 <para>Default: <command>max ttl = 259200</command></para>
4653 </listitem>
4654 </varlistentry>
4658 <varlistentry>
4659 <term><anchor id="MAXWINSTTL">max wins ttl (G)</term>
4660 <listitem><para>This option tells <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)
4661 </ulink> when acting as a WINS server (<link linkend="WINSSUPPORT">
4662 <parameter>wins support = yes</parameter></link>) what the maximum
4663 'time to live' of NetBIOS names that <command>nmbd</command>
4664 will grant will be (in seconds). You should never need to change this
4665 parameter. The default is 6 days (518400 seconds).</para>
4667 <para>See also the <link linkend="MINWINSTTL"><parameter>min
4668 wins ttl</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
4670 <para>Default: <command>max wins ttl = 518400</command></para>
4671 </listitem>
4672 </varlistentry>
4676 <varlistentry>
4677 <term><anchor id="MAXXMIT">max xmit (G)</term>
4678 <listitem><para>This option controls the maximum packet size
4679 that will be negotiated by Samba. The default is 65535, which
4680 is the maximum. In some cases you may find you get better performance
4681 with a smaller value. A value below 2048 is likely to cause problems.
4682 </para>
4684 <para>Default: <command>max xmit = 65535</command></para>
4685 <para>Example: <command>max xmit = 8192</command></para>
4686 </listitem>
4687 </varlistentry>
4691 <varlistentry>
4692 <term><anchor id="MESSAGECOMMAND">message command (G)</term>
4693 <listitem><para>This specifies what command to run when the
4694 server receives a WinPopup style message.</para>
4696 <para>This would normally be a command that would
4697 deliver the message somehow. How this is to be done is
4698 up to your imagination.</para>
4700 <para>An example is:</para>
4702 <para><command>message command = csh -c 'xedit %s;rm %s' &</command>
4703 </para>
4705 <para>This delivers the message using <command>xedit</command>, then
4706 removes it afterwards. <emphasis>NOTE THAT IT IS VERY IMPORTANT
4707 THAT THIS COMMAND RETURN IMMEDIATELY</emphasis>. That's why I
4708 have the '&' on the end. If it doesn't return immediately then
4709 your PCs may freeze when sending messages (they should recover
4710 after 30 seconds, hopefully).</para>
4712 <para>All messages are delivered as the global guest user.
4713 The command takes the standard substitutions, although <parameter>
4714 %u</parameter> won't work (<parameter>%U</parameter> may be better
4715 in this case).</para>
4717 <para>Apart from the standard substitutions, some additional
4718 ones apply. In particular:</para>
4720 <itemizedlist>
4721 <listitem><para><parameter>%s</parameter> = the filename containing
4722 the message.</para></listitem>
4724 <listitem><para><parameter>%t</parameter> = the destination that
4725 the message was sent to (probably the server name).</para></listitem>
4727 <listitem><para><parameter>%f</parameter> = who the message
4728 is from.</para></listitem>
4729 </itemizedlist>
4731 <para>You could make this command send mail, or whatever else
4732 takes your fancy. Please let us know of any really interesting
4733 ideas you have.</para>
4736 <para>Here's a way of sending the messages as mail to root:</para>
4738 <para><command>message command = /bin/mail -s 'message from %f on
4739 %m' root &lt; %s; rm %s</command></para>
4741 <para>If you don't have a message command then the message
4742 won't be delivered and Samba will tell the sender there was
4743 an error. Unfortunately WfWg totally ignores the error code
4744 and carries on regardless, saying that the message was delivered.
4745 </para>
4747 <para>If you want to silently delete it then try:</para>
4749 <para><command>message command = rm %s</command></para>
4751 <para>Default: <emphasis>no message command</emphasis></para>
4752 <para>Example: <command>message command = csh -c 'xedit %s;
4753 rm %s' &</command></para>
4754 </listitem>
4755 </varlistentry>
4760 <varlistentry>
4761 <term><anchor id="MINPASSWDLENGTH">min passwd length (G)</term>
4762 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="MINPASSWORDLENGTH">
4763 <parameter>min password length</parameter></link>.</para>
4764 </listitem>
4765 </varlistentry>
4769 <varlistentry>
4770 <term><anchor id="MINPASSWORDLENGTH">min password length (G)</term>
4771 <listitem><para>This option sets the minimum length in characters
4772 of a plaintext password that <command>smbd</command> will accept when performing
4773 UNIX password changing.</para>
4775 <para>See also <link linkend="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"><parameter>unix
4776 password sync</parameter></link>, <link linkend="PASSWDPROGRAM">
4777 <parameter>passwd program</parameter></link> and <link
4778 linkend="PASSWDCHATDEBUG"><parameter>passwd chat debug</parameter>
4779 </link>.</para>
4781 <para>Default: <command>min password length = 5</command></para>
4782 </listitem>
4783 </varlistentry>
4787 <varlistentry>
4788 <term><anchor id="MINPRINTSPACE">min print space (S)</term>
4789 <listitem><para>This sets the minimum amount of free disk
4790 space that must be available before a user will be able to spool
4791 a print job. It is specified in kilobytes. The default is 0, which
4792 means a user can always spool a print job.</para>
4794 <para>See also the <link linkend="PRINTING"><parameter>printing
4795 </parameter></link> parameter.</para>
4797 <para>Default: <command>min print space = 0</command></para>
4798 <para>Example: <command>min print space = 2000</command></para>
4799 </listitem>
4800 </varlistentry>
4805 <varlistentry>
4806 <term><anchor id="MINPROTOCOL">min protocol (G)</term>
4807 <listitem><para>The value of the parameter (a string) is the
4808 lowest SMB protocol dialect than Samba will support. Please refer
4809 to the <link linkend="MAXPROTOCOL"><parameter>max protocol</parameter></link>
4810 parameter for a list of valid protocol names and a brief description
4811 of each. You may also wish to refer to the C source code in
4812 <filename>source/smbd/negprot.c</filename> for a listing of known protocol
4813 dialects supported by clients.</para>
4815 <para>If you are viewing this parameter as a security measure, you should
4816 also refer to the <link linkend="LANMANAUTH"><parameter>lanman
4817 auth</parameter></link> parameter. Otherwise, you should never need
4818 to change this parameter.</para>
4820 <para>Default : <command>min protocol = CORE</command></para>
4821 <para>Example : <command>min protocol = NT1</command> # disable DOS
4822 clients</para>
4823 </listitem>
4824 </varlistentry>
4829 <varlistentry>
4830 <term><anchor id="MINWINSTTL">min wins ttl (G)</term>
4831 <listitem><para>This option tells <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink>
4832 when acting as a WINS server (<link linkend="WINSSUPPORT"><parameter>
4833 wins support = yes</parameter></link>) what the minimum 'time to live'
4834 of NetBIOS names that <command>nmbd</command> will grant will be (in
4835 seconds). You should never need to change this parameter. The default
4836 is 6 hours (21600 seconds).</para>
4838 <para>Default: <command>min wins ttl = 21600</command></para>
4839 </listitem>
4840 </varlistentry>
4845 <varlistentry>
4846 <term><anchor id="MSDFSROOT">msdfs root (S)</term>
4847 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter is only available if
4848 Samba is configured and compiled with the <command>
4849 --with-msdfs</command> option. If set to <constant>yes</constant>,
4850 Samba treats the share as a Dfs root and allows clients to browse
4851 the distributed file system tree rooted at the share directory.
4852 Dfs links are specified in the share directory by symbolic
4853 links of the form <filename>msdfs:serverA\shareA,serverB\shareB
4854 </filename> and so on. For more information on setting up a Dfs tree
4855 on Samba, refer to <ulink url="msdfs_setup.html">msdfs_setup.html
4856 </ulink>.</para>
4858 <para>See also <link linkend="HOSTMSDFS"><parameter>host msdfs
4859 </parameter></link></para>
4861 <para>Default: <command>msdfs root = no</command></para>
4862 </listitem>
4863 </varlistentry>
4866 <varlistentry>
4867 <term><anchor id="NAMERESOLVEORDER">name resolve order (G)</term>
4868 <listitem><para>This option is used by the programs in the Samba
4869 suite to determine what naming services to use and in what order
4870 to resolve host names to IP addresses. The option takes a space
4871 separated string of name resolution options.</para>
4873 <para>The options are :"lmhosts", "host", "wins" and "bcast". They
4874 cause names to be resolved as follows :</para>
4876 <itemizedlist>
4877 <listitem><para><constant>lmhosts</constant> : Lookup an IP
4878 address in the Samba lmhosts file. If the line in lmhosts has
4879 no name type attached to the NetBIOS name (see the <ulink
4880 url="lmhosts.5.html">lmhosts(5)</ulink> for details) then
4881 any name type matches for lookup.</para></listitem>
4883 <listitem><para><constant>host</constant> : Do a standard host
4884 name to IP address resolution, using the system <filename>/etc/hosts
4885 </filename>, NIS, or DNS lookups. This method of name resolution
4886 is operating system depended for instance on IRIX or Solaris this
4887 may be controlled by the <filename>/etc/nsswitch.conf</filename>
4888 file. Note that this method is only used if the NetBIOS name
4889 type being queried is the 0x20 (server) name type, otherwise
4890 it is ignored.</para></listitem>
4892 <listitem><para><constant>wins</constant> : Query a name with
4893 the IP address listed in the <link linkend="WINSSERVER"><parameter>
4894 wins server</parameter></link> parameter. If no WINS server has
4895 been specified this method will be ignored.</para></listitem>
4897 <listitem><para><constant>bcast</constant> : Do a broadcast on
4898 each of the known local interfaces listed in the <link
4899 linkend="INTERFACES"><parameter>interfaces</parameter></link>
4900 parameter. This is the least reliable of the name resolution
4901 methods as it depends on the target host being on a locally
4902 connected subnet.</para></listitem>
4903 </itemizedlist>
4905 <para>Default: <command>name resolve order = lmhosts host wins bcast
4906 </command></para>
4907 <para>Example: <command>name resolve order = lmhosts bcast host
4908 </command></para>
4910 <para>This will cause the local lmhosts file to be examined
4911 first, followed by a broadcast attempt, followed by a normal
4912 system hostname lookup.</para>
4913 </listitem>
4914 </varlistentry>
4919 <varlistentry>
4920 <term><anchor id="NETBIOSALIASES">netbios aliases (G)</term>
4921 <listitem><para>This is a list of NetBIOS names that <ulink
4922 url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> will advertise as additional
4923 names by which the Samba server is known. This allows one machine
4924 to appear in browse lists under multiple names. If a machine is
4925 acting as a browse server or logon server none
4926 of these names will be advertised as either browse server or logon
4927 servers, only the primary name of the machine will be advertised
4928 with these capabilities.</para>
4930 <para>See also <link linkend="NETBIOSNAME"><parameter>netbios
4931 name</parameter></link>.</para>
4933 <para>Default: <emphasis>empty string (no additional names)</emphasis></para>
4934 <para>Example: <command>netbios aliases = TEST TEST1 TEST2</command></para>
4935 </listitem>
4936 </varlistentry>
4940 <varlistentry>
4941 <term><anchor id="NETBIOSNAME">netbios name (G)</term>
4942 <listitem><para>This sets the NetBIOS name by which a Samba
4943 server is known. By default it is the same as the first component
4944 of the host's DNS name. If a machine is a browse server or
4945 logon server this name (or the first component
4946 of the hosts DNS name) will be the name that these services are
4947 advertised under.</para>
4949 <para>See also <link linkend="NETBIOSALIASES"><parameter>netbios
4950 aliases</parameter></link>.</para>
4952 <para>Default: <emphasis>machine DNS name</emphasis></para>
4953 <para>Example: <command>netbios name = MYNAME</command></para>
4954 </listitem>
4955 </varlistentry>
4959 <varlistentry>
4960 <term><anchor id="NETBIOSSCOPE">netbios scope (G)</term>
4961 <listitem><para>This sets the NetBIOS scope that Samba will
4962 operate under. This should not be set unless every machine
4963 on your LAN also sets this value.</para>
4964 </listitem>
4965 </varlistentry>
4968 <varlistentry>
4969 <term><anchor id="NISHOMEDIR">nis homedir (G)</term>
4970 <listitem><para>Get the home share server from a NIS map. For
4971 UNIX systems that use an automounter, the user's home directory
4972 will often be mounted on a workstation on demand from a remote
4973 server. </para>
4975 <para>When the Samba logon server is not the actual home directory
4976 server, but is mounting the home directories via NFS then two
4977 network hops would be required to access the users home directory
4978 if the logon server told the client to use itself as the SMB server
4979 for home directories (one over SMB and one over NFS). This can
4980 be very slow.</para>
4982 <para>This option allows Samba to return the home share as
4983 being on a different server to the logon server and as
4984 long as a Samba daemon is running on the home directory server,
4985 it will be mounted on the Samba client directly from the directory
4986 server. When Samba is returning the home share to the client, it
4987 will consult the NIS map specified in <link linkend="HOMEDIRMAP">
4988 <parameter>homedir map</parameter></link> and return the server
4989 listed there.</para>
4991 <para>Note that for this option to work there must be a working
4992 NIS system and the Samba server with this option must also
4993 be a logon server.</para>
4995 <para>Default: <command>nis homedir = no</command></para>
4996 </listitem>
4997 </varlistentry>
5001 <varlistentry>
5002 <term><anchor id="NTACLSUPPORT">nt acl support (S)</term>
5003 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether
5004 <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will attempt to map
5005 UNIX permissions into Windows NT access control lists.
5006 This parameter was formally a global parameter in releases
5007 prior to 2.2.2.</para>
5009 <para>Default: <command>nt acl support = yes</command></para>
5010 </listitem>
5011 </varlistentry>
5015 <varlistentry>
5016 <term><anchor id="NTPIPESUPPORT">nt pipe support (G)</term>
5017 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether
5018 <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will allow Windows NT
5019 clients to connect to the NT SMB specific <constant>IPC$</constant>
5020 pipes. This is a developer debugging option and can be left
5021 alone.</para>
5023 <para>Default: <command>nt pipe support = yes</command></para>
5024 </listitem>
5025 </varlistentry>
5029 <varlistentry>
5030 <term><anchor id="NTSMBSUPPORT">nt smb support (G)</term>
5031 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether <ulink
5032 url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will negotiate NT specific SMB
5033 support with Windows NT/2k/XP clients. Although this is a developer
5034 debugging option and should be left alone, benchmarking has discovered
5035 that Windows NT clients give faster performance with this option
5036 set to <constant>no</constant>. This is still being investigated.
5037 If this option is set to <constant>no</constant> then Samba offers
5038 exactly the same SMB calls that versions prior to Samba 2.0 offered.
5039 This information may be of use if any users are having problems
5040 with NT SMB support.</para>
5042 <para>You should not need to ever disable this parameter.</para>
5044 <para>Default: <command>nt smb support = yes</command></para>
5045 </listitem>
5046 </varlistentry>
5050 <varlistentry>
5051 <term><anchor id="NTSTATUSSUPPORT">nt status support (G)</term>
5052 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether <ulink
5053 url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will negotiate NT specific status
5054 support with Windows NT/2k/XP clients. This is a developer
5055 debugging option and should be left alone.
5056 If this option is set to <constant>no</constant> then Samba offers
5057 exactly the same DOS error codes that versions prior to Samba 2.2.3
5058 reported.</para>
5060 <para>You should not need to ever disable this parameter.</para>
5062 <para>Default: <command>nt status support = yes</command></para>
5063 </listitem>
5064 </varlistentry>
5068 <varlistentry>
5069 <term><anchor id="NULLPASSWORDS">null passwords (G)</term>
5070 <listitem><para>Allow or disallow client access to accounts
5071 that have null passwords. </para>
5073 <para>See also <ulink url="smbpasswd.5.html">smbpasswd (5)</ulink>.</para>
5075 <para>Default: <command>null passwords = no</command></para>
5076 </listitem>
5077 </varlistentry>
5082 <varlistentry>
5083 <term><anchor id="OBEYPAMRESTRICTIONS">obey pam restrictions (G)</term>
5084 <listitem><para>When Samba 2.2 is configured to enable PAM support
5085 (i.e. --with-pam), this parameter will control whether or not Samba
5086 should obey PAM's account and session management directives. The
5087 default behavior is to use PAM for clear text authentication only
5088 and to ignore any account or session management. Note that Samba
5089 always ignores PAM for authentication in the case of <link
5090 linkend="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"><parameter>encrypt passwords = yes</parameter>
5091 </link>. The reason is that PAM modules cannot support the challenge/response
5092 authentication mechanism needed in the presence of SMB password encryption.
5093 </para>
5095 <para>Default: <command>obey pam restrictions = no</command></para>
5096 </listitem>
5097 </varlistentry>
5103 <varlistentry>
5104 <term><anchor id="ONLYUSER">only user (S)</term>
5105 <listitem><para>This is a boolean option that controls whether
5106 connections with usernames not in the <parameter>user</parameter>
5107 list will be allowed. By default this option is disabled so that a
5108 client can supply a username to be used by the server. Enabling
5109 this parameter will force the server to only user the login
5110 names from the <parameter>user</parameter> list and is only really
5111 useful in <link linkend="SECURITYEQUALSSHARE">shave level</link>
5112 security.</para>
5114 <para>Note that this also means Samba won't try to deduce
5115 usernames from the service name. This can be annoying for
5116 the [homes] section. To get around this you could use <command>user =
5117 %S</command> which means your <parameter>user</parameter> list
5118 will be just the service name, which for home directories is the
5119 name of the user.</para>
5121 <para>See also the <link linkend="USER"><parameter>user</parameter>
5122 </link> parameter.</para>
5124 <para>Default: <command>only user = no</command></para>
5125 </listitem>
5126 </varlistentry>
5131 <varlistentry>
5132 <term><anchor id="ONLYGUEST">only guest (S)</term>
5133 <listitem><para>A synonym for <link linkend="GUESTONLY"><parameter>
5134 guest only</parameter></link>.</para>
5135 </listitem>
5136 </varlistentry>
5140 <varlistentry>
5141 <term><anchor id="OPLOCKBREAKWAITTIME">oplock break wait time (G)</term>
5142 <listitem><para>This is a tuning parameter added due to bugs in
5143 both Windows 9x and WinNT. If Samba responds to a client too
5144 quickly when that client issues an SMB that can cause an oplock
5145 break request, then the network client can fail and not respond
5146 to the break request. This tuning parameter (which is set in milliseconds)
5147 is the amount of time Samba will wait before sending an oplock break
5148 request to such (broken) clients.</para>
5150 <para><emphasis>DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ
5151 AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE</emphasis>.</para>
5153 <para>Default: <command>oplock break wait time = 0</command></para>
5154 </listitem>
5155 </varlistentry>
5158 <varlistentry>
5159 <term><anchor id="OPLOCKCONTENTIONLIMIT">oplock contention limit (S)</term>
5160 <listitem><para>This is a <emphasis>very</emphasis> advanced
5161 <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> tuning option to
5162 improve the efficiency of the granting of oplocks under multiple
5163 client contention for the same file.</para>
5165 <para>In brief it specifies a number, which causes <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> not to
5166 grant an oplock even when requested if the approximate number of
5167 clients contending for an oplock on the same file goes over this
5168 limit. This causes <command>smbd</command> to behave in a similar
5169 way to Windows NT.</para>
5171 <para><emphasis>DO NOT CHANGE THIS PARAMETER UNLESS YOU HAVE READ
5172 AND UNDERSTOOD THE SAMBA OPLOCK CODE</emphasis>.</para>
5174 <para>Default: <command>oplock contention limit = 2</command></para>
5175 </listitem>
5176 </varlistentry>
5182 <varlistentry>
5183 <term><anchor id="OPLOCKS">oplocks (S)</term>
5184 <listitem><para>This boolean option tells <command>smbd</command> whether to
5185 issue oplocks (opportunistic locks) to file open requests on this
5186 share. The oplock code can dramatically (approx. 30% or more) improve
5187 the speed of access to files on Samba servers. It allows the clients
5188 to aggressively cache files locally and you may want to disable this
5189 option for unreliable network environments (it is turned on by
5190 default in Windows NT Servers). For more information see the file
5191 <filename>Speed.txt</filename> in the Samba <filename>docs/</filename>
5192 directory.</para>
5194 <para>Oplocks may be selectively turned off on certain files with a
5195 share. See the <link linkend="VETOOPLOCKFILES"><parameter>
5196 veto oplock files</parameter></link> parameter. On some systems
5197 oplocks are recognized by the underlying operating system. This
5198 allows data synchronization between all access to oplocked files,
5199 whether it be via Samba or NFS or a local UNIX process. See the
5200 <parameter>kernel oplocks</parameter> parameter for details.</para>
5202 <para>See also the <link linkend="KERNELOPLOCKS"><parameter>kernel
5203 oplocks</parameter></link> and <link linkend="LEVEL2OPLOCKS"><parameter>
5204 level2 oplocks</parameter></link> parameters.</para>
5206 <para>Default: <command>oplocks = yes</command></para>
5207 </listitem>
5208 </varlistentry>
5212 <varlistentry>
5213 <term><anchor id="OSLEVEL">os level (G)</term>
5214 <listitem><para>This integer value controls what level Samba
5215 advertises itself as for browse elections. The value of this
5216 parameter determines whether <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink>
5217 has a chance of becoming a local master browser for the <parameter>
5218 WORKGROUP</parameter> in the local broadcast area.</para>
5220 <para><emphasis>Note :</emphasis>By default, Samba will win
5221 a local master browsing election over all Microsoft operating
5222 systems except a Windows NT 4.0/2000 Domain Controller. This
5223 means that a misconfigured Samba host can effectively isolate
5224 a subnet for browsing purposes. See <filename>BROWSING.txt
5225 </filename> in the Samba <filename>docs/</filename> directory
5226 for details.</para>
5228 <para>Default: <command>os level = 20</command></para>
5229 <para>Example: <command>os level = 65 </command></para>
5230 </listitem>
5231 </varlistentry>
5235 <varlistentry>
5236 <term><anchor id="OS2DRIVERMAP">os2 driver map (G)</term>
5237 <listitem><para>The parameter is used to define the absolute
5238 path to a file containing a mapping of Windows NT printer driver
5239 names to OS/2 printer driver names. The format is:</para>
5241 <para>&lt;nt driver name&gt; = &lt;os2 driver
5242 name&gt;.&lt;device name&gt;</para>
5244 <para>For example, a valid entry using the HP LaserJet 5
5245 printer driver would appear as <command>HP LaserJet 5L = LASERJET.HP
5246 LaserJet 5L</command>.</para>
5248 <para>The need for the file is due to the printer driver namespace
5249 problem described in the <ulink url="printer_driver2.html">Samba
5250 Printing HOWTO</ulink>. For more details on OS/2 clients, please
5251 refer to the <ulink url="OS2-Client-HOWTO.html">OS2-Client-HOWTO
5252 </ulink> containing in the Samba documentation.</para>
5254 <para>Default: <command>os2 driver map = &lt;empty string&gt;
5255 </command></para>
5256 </listitem>
5257 </varlistentry>
5260 <varlistentry>
5261 <term><anchor id="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE">pam password change (G)</term>
5262 <listitem><para>With the addition of better PAM support in Samba 2.2,
5263 this parameter, it is possible to use PAM's password change control
5264 flag for Samba. If enabled, then PAM will be used for password
5265 changes when requested by an SMB client instead of the program listed in
5266 <link linkend="PASSWDPROGRAM"><parameter>passwd program</parameter></link>.
5267 It should be possible to enable this without changing your
5268 <link linkend="PASSWDCHAT"><parameter>passwd chat</parameter></link>
5269 parameter for most setups.
5270 </para>
5272 <para>Default: <command>pam password change = no</command></para>
5274 </listitem>
5275 </varlistentry>
5278 <varlistentry>
5279 <term><anchor id="PANICACTION">panic action (G)</term>
5280 <listitem><para>This is a Samba developer option that allows a
5281 system command to be called when either <ulink url="smbd.8.html">
5282 smbd(8)</ulink> or <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink>
5283 crashes. This is usually used to draw attention to the fact that
5284 a problem occurred.</para>
5286 <para>Default: <command>panic action = &lt;empty string&gt;</command></para>
5287 <para>Example: <command>panic action = "/bin/sleep 90000"</command></para>
5288 </listitem>
5289 </varlistentry>
5292 <varlistentry>
5293 <term><anchor id="PASSWDCHAT">passwd chat (G)</term>
5294 <listitem><para>This string controls the <emphasis>"chat"</emphasis>
5295 conversation that takes places between <ulink
5296 url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> and the local password changing
5297 program to change the user's password. The string describes a
5298 sequence of response-receive pairs that <ulink url="smbd.8.html">
5299 smbd(8)</ulink> uses to determine what to send to the
5300 <link linkend="PASSWDPROGRAM"><parameter>passwd program</parameter>
5301 </link> and what to expect back. If the expected output is not
5302 received then the password is not changed.</para>
5304 <para>This chat sequence is often quite site specific, depending
5305 on what local methods are used for password control (such as NIS
5306 etc).</para>
5307 <para>Note that this parameter only is only used if the <link
5308 linkend="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"><parameter>unix
5309 password sync</parameter></link> parameter is set to <constant>yes</constant>. This
5310 sequence is then called <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis> when the SMB password
5311 in the smbpasswd file is being changed, without access to the old
5312 password cleartext. This means that root must be able to reset the user's password
5313 without knowing the text of the previous password. In the presence of NIS/YP,
5314 this means that the <link linkend="PASSWDPROGRAM">passwd program</link> must be
5315 executed on the NIS master.
5316 </para>
5319 <para>The string can contain the macro <parameter>%n</parameter> which is substituted
5320 for the new password. The chat sequence can also contain the standard
5321 macros <constant>\n</constant>, <constant>\r</constant>, <constant>
5322 \t</constant> and <constant>\s</constant> to give line-feed,
5323 carriage-return, tab and space. The chat sequence string can also contain
5324 a '*' which matches any sequence of characters.
5325 Double quotes can be used to collect strings with spaces
5326 in them into a single string.</para>
5328 <para>If the send string in any part of the chat sequence
5329 is a full stop ".", then no string is sent. Similarly,
5330 if the expect string is a full stop then no string is expected.</para>
5332 <para>If the <link linkend="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"><parameter>pam
5333 password change</parameter></link> parameter is set to true, the chat pairs
5334 may be matched in any order, and success is determined by the PAM result,
5335 not any particular output. The \n macro is ignored for PAM conversions.
5336 </para>
5338 <para>See also <link linkend="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"><parameter>unix password
5339 sync</parameter></link>, <link linkend="PASSWDPROGRAM"><parameter>
5340 passwd program</parameter></link> ,<link linkend="PASSWDCHATDEBUG">
5341 <parameter>passwd chat debug</parameter></link> and <link linkend="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE">
5342 <parameter>pam password change</parameter></link>.</para>
5344 <para>Default: <command>passwd chat = *new*password* %n\n
5345 *new*password* %n\n *changed*</command></para>
5346 <para>Example: <command>passwd chat = "*Enter OLD password*" %o\n
5347 "*Enter NEW password*" %n\n "*Reenter NEW password*" %n\n "*Password
5348 changed*"</command></para>
5349 </listitem>
5350 </varlistentry>
5354 <varlistentry>
5355 <term><anchor id="PASSWDCHATDEBUG">passwd chat debug (G)</term>
5356 <listitem><para>This boolean specifies if the passwd chat script
5357 parameter is run in <emphasis>debug</emphasis> mode. In this mode the
5358 strings passed to and received from the passwd chat are printed
5359 in the <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> log with a
5360 <link linkend="DEBUGLEVEL"><parameter>debug level</parameter></link>
5361 of 100. This is a dangerous option as it will allow plaintext passwords
5362 to be seen in the <command>smbd</command> log. It is available to help
5363 Samba admins debug their <parameter>passwd chat</parameter> scripts
5364 when calling the <parameter>passwd program</parameter> and should
5365 be turned off after this has been done. This option has no effect if the
5366 <link linkend="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"><parameter>pam password change</parameter></link>
5367 paramter is set. This parameter is off by default.</para>
5370 <para>See also <link linkend="PASSWDCHAT"><parameter>passwd chat</parameter>
5371 </link>, <link linkend="PAMPASSWORDCHANGE"><parameter>pam password change</parameter>
5372 </link>, <link linkend="PASSWDPROGRAM"><parameter>passwd program</parameter>
5373 </link>.</para>
5375 <para>Default: <command>passwd chat debug = no</command></para>
5376 </listitem>
5377 </varlistentry>
5381 <varlistentry>
5382 <term><anchor id="PASSWDPROGRAM">passwd program (G)</term>
5383 <listitem><para>The name of a program that can be used to set
5384 UNIX user passwords. Any occurrences of <parameter>%u</parameter>
5385 will be replaced with the user name. The user name is checked for
5386 existence before calling the password changing program.</para>
5388 <para>Also note that many passwd programs insist in <emphasis>reasonable
5389 </emphasis> passwords, such as a minimum length, or the inclusion
5390 of mixed case chars and digits. This can pose a problem as some clients
5391 (such as Windows for Workgroups) uppercase the password before sending
5392 it.</para>
5394 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that if the <parameter>unix
5395 password sync</parameter> parameter is set to <constant>true
5396 </constant> then this program is called <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis>
5397 before the SMB password in the <ulink url="smbpasswd.5.html">smbpasswd(5)
5398 </ulink> file is changed. If this UNIX password change fails, then
5399 <command>smbd</command> will fail to change the SMB password also
5400 (this is by design).</para>
5402 <para>If the <parameter>unix password sync</parameter> parameter
5403 is set this parameter <emphasis>MUST USE ABSOLUTE PATHS</emphasis>
5404 for <emphasis>ALL</emphasis> programs called, and must be examined
5405 for security implications. Note that by default <parameter>unix
5406 password sync</parameter> is set to <constant>false</constant>.</para>
5408 <para>See also <link linkend="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC"><parameter>unix
5409 password sync</parameter></link>.</para>
5411 <para>Default: <command>passwd program = /bin/passwd</command></para>
5412 <para>Example: <command>passwd program = /sbin/npasswd %u</command>
5413 </para>
5414 </listitem>
5415 </varlistentry>
5419 <varlistentry>
5420 <term><anchor id="PASSWORDLEVEL">password level (G)</term>
5421 <listitem><para>Some client/server combinations have difficulty
5422 with mixed-case passwords. One offending client is Windows for
5423 Workgroups, which for some reason forces passwords to upper
5424 case when using the LANMAN1 protocol, but leaves them alone when
5425 using COREPLUS! Another problem child is the Windows 95/98
5426 family of operating systems. These clients upper case clear
5427 text passwords even when NT LM 0.12 selected by the protocol
5428 negotiation request/response.</para>
5430 <para>This parameter defines the maximum number of characters
5431 that may be upper case in passwords.</para>
5433 <para>For example, say the password given was "FRED". If <parameter>
5434 password level</parameter> is set to 1, the following combinations
5435 would be tried if "FRED" failed:</para>
5437 <para>"Fred", "fred", "fRed", "frEd","freD"</para>
5439 <para>If <parameter>password level</parameter> was set to 2,
5440 the following combinations would also be tried: </para>
5442 <para>"FRed", "FrEd", "FreD", "fREd", "fReD", "frED", ..</para>
5444 <para>And so on.</para>
5446 <para>The higher value this parameter is set to the more likely
5447 it is that a mixed case password will be matched against a single
5448 case password. However, you should be aware that use of this
5449 parameter reduces security and increases the time taken to
5450 process a new connection.</para>
5452 <para>A value of zero will cause only two attempts to be
5453 made - the password as is and the password in all-lower case.</para>
5455 <para>Default: <command>password level = 0</command></para>
5456 <para>Example: <command>password level = 4</command></para>
5457 </listitem>
5458 </varlistentry>
5462 <varlistentry>
5463 <term><anchor id="PASSWORDSERVER">password server (G)</term>
5464 <listitem><para>By specifying the name of another SMB server (such
5465 as a WinNT box) with this option, and using <command>security = domain
5466 </command> or <command>security = server</command> you can get Samba
5467 to do all its username/password validation via a remote server.</para>
5469 <para>This option sets the name of the password server to use.
5470 It must be a NetBIOS name, so if the machine's NetBIOS name is
5471 different from its Internet name then you may have to add its NetBIOS
5472 name to the lmhosts file which is stored in the same directory
5473 as the <filename>smb.conf</filename> file.</para>
5475 <para>The name of the password server is looked up using the
5476 parameter <link linkend="NAMERESOLVEORDER"><parameter>name
5477 resolve order</parameter></link> and so may resolved
5478 by any method and order described in that parameter.</para>
5480 <para>The password server much be a machine capable of using
5481 the "LM1.2X002" or the "NT LM 0.12" protocol, and it must be in
5482 user level security mode.</para>
5484 <para><emphasis>NOTE:</emphasis> Using a password server
5485 means your UNIX box (running Samba) is only as secure as your
5486 password server. <emphasis>DO NOT CHOOSE A PASSWORD SERVER THAT
5487 YOU DON'T COMPLETELY TRUST</emphasis>.</para>
5489 <para>Never point a Samba server at itself for password
5490 serving. This will cause a loop and could lock up your Samba
5491 server!</para>
5493 <para>The name of the password server takes the standard
5494 substitutions, but probably the only useful one is <parameter>%m
5495 </parameter>, which means the Samba server will use the incoming
5496 client as the password server. If you use this then you better
5497 trust your clients, and you had better restrict them with hosts allow!</para>
5499 <para>If the <parameter>security</parameter> parameter is set to
5500 <constant>domain</constant>, then the list of machines in this
5501 option must be a list of Primary or Backup Domain controllers for the
5502 Domain or the character '*', as the Samba server is effectively
5503 in that domain, and will use cryptographically authenticated RPC calls
5504 to authenticate the user logging on. The advantage of using <command>
5505 security = domain</command> is that if you list several hosts in the
5506 <parameter>password server</parameter> option then <command>smbd
5507 </command> will try each in turn till it finds one that responds. This
5508 is useful in case your primary server goes down.</para>
5510 <para>If the <parameter>password server</parameter> option is set
5511 to the character '*', then Samba will attempt to auto-locate the
5512 Primary or Backup Domain controllers to authenticate against by
5513 doing a query for the name <constant>WORKGROUP&lt;1C&gt;</constant>
5514 and then contacting each server returned in the list of IP
5515 addresses from the name resolution source. </para>
5517 <para>If the <parameter>security</parameter> parameter is
5518 set to <constant>server</constant>, then there are different
5519 restrictions that <command>security = domain</command> doesn't
5520 suffer from:</para>
5522 <itemizedlist>
5523 <listitem><para>You may list several password servers in
5524 the <parameter>password server</parameter> parameter, however if an
5525 <command>smbd</command> makes a connection to a password server,
5526 and then the password server fails, no more users will be able
5527 to be authenticated from this <command>smbd</command>. This is a
5528 restriction of the SMB/CIFS protocol when in <command>security = server
5529 </command> mode and cannot be fixed in Samba.</para></listitem>
5531 <listitem><para>If you are using a Windows NT server as your
5532 password server then you will have to ensure that your users
5533 are able to login from the Samba server, as when in <command>
5534 security = server</command> mode the network logon will appear to
5535 come from there rather than from the users workstation.</para></listitem>
5536 </itemizedlist>
5538 <para>See also the <link linkend="SECURITY"><parameter>security
5539 </parameter></link> parameter.</para>
5541 <para>Default: <command>password server = &lt;empty string&gt;</command>
5542 </para>
5543 <para>Example: <command>password server = NT-PDC, NT-BDC1, NT-BDC2
5544 </command></para>
5545 <para>Example: <command>password server = *</command></para>
5546 </listitem>
5547 </varlistentry>
5551 <varlistentry>
5552 <term><anchor id="PATH">path (S)</term>
5553 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies a directory to which
5554 the user of the service is to be given access. In the case of
5555 printable services, this is where print data will spool prior to
5556 being submitted to the host for printing.</para>
5558 <para>For a printable service offering guest access, the service
5559 should be readonly and the path should be world-writeable and
5560 have the sticky bit set. This is not mandatory of course, but
5561 you probably won't get the results you expect if you do
5562 otherwise.</para>
5564 <para>Any occurrences of <parameter>%u</parameter> in the path
5565 will be replaced with the UNIX username that the client is using
5566 on this connection. Any occurrences of <parameter>%m</parameter>
5567 will be replaced by the NetBIOS name of the machine they are
5568 connecting from. These replacements are very useful for setting
5569 up pseudo home directories for users.</para>
5571 <para>Note that this path will be based on <link linkend="ROOTDIR">
5572 <parameter>root dir</parameter></link> if one was specified.</para>
5574 <para>Default: <emphasis>none</emphasis></para>
5575 <para>Example: <command>path = /home/fred</command></para>
5576 </listitem>
5577 </varlistentry>
5582 <varlistentry>
5583 <term><anchor id="PIDDIRECTORY">pid directory (G)</term>
5584 <listitem><para>This option specifies the directory where pid
5585 files will be placed. </para>
5587 <para>Default: <command>pid directory = ${prefix}/var/locks</command></para>
5588 <para>Example: <command>pid directory = /var/run/</command>
5589 </para></listitem>
5590 </varlistentry>
5594 <varlistentry>
5595 <term><anchor id="POSIXLOCKING">posix locking (S)</term>
5596 <listitem><para>The <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>
5597 daemon maintains an database of file locks obtained by SMB clients.
5598 The default behavior is to map this internal database to POSIX
5599 locks. This means that file locks obtained by SMB clients are
5600 consistent with those seen by POSIX compliant applications accessing
5601 the files via a non-SMB method (e.g. NFS or local file access).
5602 You should never need to disable this parameter.</para>
5604 <para>Default: <command>posix locking = yes</command></para>
5605 </listitem>
5606 </varlistentry>
5611 <varlistentry>
5612 <term><anchor id="POSTEXEC">postexec (S)</term>
5613 <listitem><para>This option specifies a command to be run
5614 whenever the service is disconnected. It takes the usual
5615 substitutions. The command may be run as the root on some
5616 systems.</para>
5618 <para>An interesting example may be to unmount server
5619 resources:</para>
5621 <para><command>postexec = /etc/umount /cdrom</command></para>
5623 <para>See also <link linkend="PREEXEC"><parameter>preexec</parameter>
5624 </link>.</para>
5626 <para>Default: <emphasis>none (no command executed)</emphasis>
5627 </para>
5629 <para>Example: <command>postexec = echo \"%u disconnected from %S
5630 from %m (%I)\" &gt;&gt; /tmp/log</command></para>
5631 </listitem>
5632 </varlistentry>
5636 <varlistentry>
5637 <term><anchor id="POSTSCRIPT">postscript (S)</term>
5638 <listitem><para>This parameter forces a printer to interpret
5639 the print files as PostScript. This is done by adding a <constant>%!
5640 </constant> to the start of print output.</para>
5642 <para>This is most useful when you have lots of PCs that persist
5643 in putting a control-D at the start of print jobs, which then
5644 confuses your printer.</para>
5646 <para>Default: <command>postscript = no</command></para>
5647 </listitem>
5648 </varlistentry>
5652 <varlistentry>
5653 <term><anchor id="PREEXEC">preexec (S)</term>
5654 <listitem><para>This option specifies a command to be run whenever
5655 the service is connected to. It takes the usual substitutions.</para>
5657 <para>An interesting example is to send the users a welcome
5658 message every time they log in. Maybe a message of the day? Here
5659 is an example:</para>
5661 <para><command>preexec = csh -c 'echo \"Welcome to %S!\" |
5662 /usr/local/samba/bin/smbclient -M %m -I %I' & </command></para>
5664 <para>Of course, this could get annoying after a while :-)</para>
5666 <para>See also <link linkend="PREEXECCLOSE"><parameter>preexec close
5667 </parameter</link> and <link linkend="POSTEXEC"><parameter>postexec
5668 </parameter></link>.</para>
5670 <para>Default: <emphasis>none (no command executed)</emphasis></para>
5671 <para>Example: <command>preexec = echo \"%u connected to %S from %m
5672 (%I)\" &gt;&gt; /tmp/log</command></para>
5673 </listitem>
5674 </varlistentry>
5678 <varlistentry>
5679 <term><anchor id="PREEXECCLOSE">preexec close (S)</term>
5680 <listitem><para>This boolean option controls whether a non-zero
5681 return code from <link linkend="PREEXEC"><parameter>preexec
5682 </parameter></link> should close the service being connected to.</para>
5684 <para>Default: <command>preexec close = no</command></para>
5685 </listitem>
5686 </varlistentry>
5689 <varlistentry>
5690 <term><anchor id="PREFERREDMASTER">preferred master (G)</term>
5691 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls if <ulink
5692 url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> is a preferred master browser
5693 for its workgroup.</para>
5695 <para>If this is set to <constant>true</constant>, on startup, <command>nmbd</command>
5696 will force an election, and it will have a slight advantage in
5697 winning the election. It is recommended that this parameter is
5698 used in conjunction with <command><link linkend="DOMAINMASTER"><parameter>
5699 domain master</parameter></link> = yes</command>, so that <command>
5700 nmbd</command> can guarantee becoming a domain master.</para>
5702 <para>Use this option with caution, because if there are several
5703 hosts (whether Samba servers, Windows 95 or NT) that are preferred
5704 master browsers on the same subnet, they will each periodically
5705 and continuously attempt to become the local master browser.
5706 This will result in unnecessary broadcast traffic and reduced browsing
5707 capabilities.</para>
5709 <para>See also <link linkend="OSLEVEL"><parameter>os level</parameter>
5710 </link>.</para>
5712 <para>Default: <command>preferred master = auto</command></para>
5713 </listitem>
5714 </varlistentry>
5718 <varlistentry>
5719 <term><anchor id="PREFEREDMASTER">prefered master (G)</term>
5720 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="PREFERREDMASTER"><parameter>
5721 preferred master</parameter></link> for people who cannot spell :-).</para>
5722 </listitem>
5723 </varlistentry>
5727 <varlistentry>
5728 <term><anchor id="PRELOAD">preload</term>
5729 <listitem><para>This is a list of services that you want to be
5730 automatically added to the browse lists. This is most useful
5731 for homes and printers services that would otherwise not be
5732 visible.</para>
5734 <para>Note that if you just want all printers in your
5735 printcap file loaded then the <link linkend="LOADPRINTERS">
5736 <parameter>load printers</parameter></link> option is easier.</para>
5738 <para>Default: <emphasis>no preloaded services</emphasis></para>
5740 <para>Example: <command>preload = fred lp colorlp</command></para>
5741 </listitem>
5742 </varlistentry>
5745 <varlistentry>
5746 <term><anchor id="PRESERVECASE">preserve case (S)</term>
5747 <listitem><para> This controls if new filenames are created
5748 with the case that the client passes, or if they are forced to
5749 be the <link linkend="DEFAULTCASE"><parameter>default case
5750 </parameter></link>.</para>
5752 <para>Default: <command>preserve case = yes</command></para>
5754 <para>See the section on <link linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">NAME
5755 MANGLING</link> for a fuller discussion.</para>
5756 </listitem>
5757 </varlistentry>
5761 <varlistentry>
5762 <term><anchor id="PRINTCOMMAND">print command (S)</term>
5763 <listitem><para>After a print job has finished spooling to
5764 a service, this command will be used via a <command>system()</command>
5765 call to process the spool file. Typically the command specified will
5766 submit the spool file to the host's printing subsystem, but there
5767 is no requirement that this be the case. The server will not remove
5768 the spool file, so whatever command you specify should remove the
5769 spool file when it has been processed, otherwise you will need to
5770 manually remove old spool files.</para>
5772 <para>The print command is simply a text string. It will be used
5773 verbatim after macro substitutions have been made:</para>
5775 <para>s, %p - the path to the spool
5776 file name</para>
5778 <para>%p - the appropriate printer
5779 name</para>
5781 <para>%J - the job
5782 name as transmitted by the client.</para>
5784 <para>%c - The number of printed pages
5785 of the spooled job (if known).</para>
5787 <para>%z - the size of the spooled
5788 print job (in bytes)</para>
5790 <para>The print command <emphasis>MUST</emphasis> contain at least
5791 one occurrence of <parameter>%s</parameter> or <parameter>%f
5792 </parameter> - the <parameter>%p</parameter> is optional. At the time
5793 a job is submitted, if no printer name is supplied the <parameter>%p
5794 </parameter> will be silently removed from the printer command.</para>
5796 <para>If specified in the [global] section, the print command given
5797 will be used for any printable service that does not have its own
5798 print command specified.</para>
5800 <para>If there is neither a specified print command for a
5801 printable service nor a global print command, spool files will
5802 be created but not processed and (most importantly) not removed.</para>
5804 <para>Note that printing may fail on some UNIXes from the
5805 <constant>nobody</constant> account. If this happens then create
5806 an alternative guest account that can print and set the <link
5807 linkend="GUESTACCOUNT"><parameter>guest account</parameter></link>
5808 in the [global] section.</para>
5810 <para>You can form quite complex print commands by realizing
5811 that they are just passed to a shell. For example the following
5812 will log a print job, print the file, then remove it. Note that
5813 ';' is the usual separator for command in shell scripts.</para>
5815 <para><command>print command = echo Printing %s &gt;&gt;
5816 /tmp/print.log; lpr -P %p %s; rm %s</command></para>
5818 <para>You may have to vary this command considerably depending
5819 on how you normally print files on your system. The default for
5820 the parameter varies depending on the setting of the <link linkend="PRINTING">
5821 <parameter>printing</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
5823 <para>Default: For <command>printing = BSD, AIX, QNX, LPRNG
5824 or PLP :</command></para>
5825 <para><command>print command = lpr -r -P%p %s</command></para>
5827 <para>For <command>printing = SYSV or HPUX :</command></para>
5828 <para><command>print command = lp -c -d%p %s; rm %s</command></para>
5830 <para>For <command>printing = SOFTQ :</command></para>
5831 <para><command>print command = lp -d%p -s %s; rm %s</command></para>
5833 <para>For printing = CUPS : If SAMBA is compiled against
5834 libcups, then <link linkend="PRINTING">printcap = cups</link>
5835 uses the CUPS API to
5836 submit jobs, etc. Otherwise it maps to the System V
5837 commands with the -oraw option for printing, i.e. it
5838 uses <command>lp -c -d%p -oraw; rm %s</command>.
5839 With <command>printing = cups</command>,
5840 and if SAMBA is compiled against libcups, any manually
5841 set print command will be ignored.</para>
5844 <para>Example: <command>print command = /usr/local/samba/bin/myprintscript
5845 %p %s</command></para>
5846 </listitem>
5847 </varlistentry>
5851 <varlistentry>
5852 <term><anchor id="PRINTOK">print ok (S)</term>
5853 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="PRINTABLE">
5854 <parameter>printable</parameter></link>.</para>
5855 </listitem>
5856 </varlistentry>
5861 <varlistentry>
5862 <term><anchor id="PRINTABLE">printable (S)</term>
5863 <listitem><para>If this parameter is <constant>yes</constant>, then
5864 clients may open, write to and submit spool files on the directory
5865 specified for the service. </para>
5867 <para>Note that a printable service will ALWAYS allow writing
5868 to the service path (user privileges permitting) via the spooling
5869 of print data. The <link linkend="WRITEABLE"><parameter>writeable
5870 </parameter></link> parameter controls only non-printing access to
5871 the resource.</para>
5873 <para>Default: <command>printable = no</command></para>
5874 </listitem>
5875 </varlistentry>
5879 <varlistentry>
5880 <term><anchor id="PRINTCAP">printcap (G)</term>
5881 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="PRINTCAPNAME"><parameter>
5882 printcap name</parameter></link>.</para>
5883 </listitem>
5884 </varlistentry>
5889 <varlistentry>
5890 <term><anchor id="PRINTCAPNAME">printcap name (G)</term>
5891 <listitem><para>This parameter may be used to override the
5892 compiled-in default printcap name used by the server (usually <filename>
5893 /etc/printcap</filename>). See the discussion of the <link
5894 linkend="PRINTERSSECT">[printers]</link> section above for reasons
5895 why you might want to do this.</para>
5897 <para>To use the CUPS printing interface set <command>printcap name = cups
5898 </command>. This should be supplemented by an addtional setting
5899 <link linkend="PRINTING">printing = cups</link> in the [global]
5900 section. <command>printcap name = cups</command> will use the
5901 "dummy" printcap created by CUPS, as specified in your CUPS
5902 configuration file.
5903 </para>
5905 <para>On System V systems that use <command>lpstat</command> to
5906 list available printers you can use <command>printcap name = lpstat
5907 </command> to automatically obtain lists of available printers. This
5908 is the default for systems that define SYSV at configure time in
5909 Samba (this includes most System V based systems). If <parameter>
5910 printcap name</parameter> is set to <command>lpstat</command> on
5911 these systems then Samba will launch <command>lpstat -v</command> and
5912 attempt to parse the output to obtain a printer list.</para>
5914 <para>A minimal printcap file would look something like this:</para>
5916 <para><programlisting>
5917 print1|My Printer 1
5918 print2|My Printer 2
5919 print3|My Printer 3
5920 print4|My Printer 4
5921 print5|My Printer 5
5922 </programlisting></para>
5924 <para>where the '|' separates aliases of a printer. The fact
5925 that the second alias has a space in it gives a hint to Samba
5926 that it's a comment.</para>
5928 <para><emphasis>NOTE</emphasis>: Under AIX the default printcap
5929 name is <filename>/etc/qconfig</filename>. Samba will assume the
5930 file is in AIX <filename>qconfig</filename> format if the string
5931 <filename>qconfig</filename> appears in the printcap filename.</para>
5933 <para>Default: <command>printcap name = /etc/printcap</command></para>
5934 <para>Example: <command>printcap name = /etc/myprintcap</command></para>
5935 </listitem>
5936 </varlistentry>
5942 <varlistentry>
5943 <term><anchor id="PRINTERADMIN">printer admin (S)</term>
5944 <listitem><para>This is a list of users that can do anything to
5945 printers via the remote administration interfaces offered by MS-RPC
5946 (usually using a NT workstation). Note that the root user always
5947 has admin rights.</para>
5949 <para>Default: <command>printer admin = &lt;empty string&gt;</command>
5950 </para>
5951 <para>Example: <command>printer admin = admin, @staff</command></para>
5952 </listitem>
5953 </varlistentry>
5959 <varlistentry>
5960 <term><anchor id="PRINTERDRIVER">printer driver (S)</term>
5961 <listitem><para><emphasis>Note :</emphasis>This is a deprecated
5962 parameter and will be removed in the next major release
5963 following version 2.2. Please see the instructions in
5964 the <ulink url="printer_driver2.html">Samba 2.2. Printing
5965 HOWTO</ulink> for more information
5966 on the new method of loading printer drivers onto a Samba server.
5967 </para>
5969 <para>This option allows you to control the string
5970 that clients receive when they ask the server for the printer driver
5971 associated with a printer. If you are using Windows95 or Windows NT
5972 then you can use this to automate the setup of printers on your
5973 system.</para>
5975 <para>You need to set this parameter to the exact string (case
5976 sensitive) that describes the appropriate printer driver for your
5977 system. If you don't know the exact string to use then you should
5978 first try with no <link linkend="PRINTERDRIVER"><parameter>
5979 printer driver</parameter></link> option set and the client will
5980 give you a list of printer drivers. The appropriate strings are
5981 shown in a scroll box after you have chosen the printer manufacturer.</para>
5983 <para>See also <link linkend="PRINTERDRIVERFILE"><parameter>printer
5984 driver file</parameter></link>.</para>
5986 <para>Example: <command>printer driver = HP LaserJet 4L</command></para>
5987 </listitem>
5988 </varlistentry>
5992 <varlistentry>
5993 <term><anchor id="PRINTERDRIVERFILE">printer driver file (G)</term>
5994 <listitem><para><emphasis>Note :</emphasis>This is a deprecated
5995 parameter and will be removed in the next major release
5996 following version 2.2. Please see the instructions in
5997 the <ulink url="printer_driver2.html">Samba 2.2. Printing
5998 HOWTO</ulink> for more information
5999 on the new method of loading printer drivers onto a Samba server.
6000 </para>
6002 <para>This parameter tells Samba where the printer driver
6003 definition file, used when serving drivers to Windows 95 clients, is
6004 to be found. If this is not set, the default is :</para>
6006 <para><filename><replaceable>SAMBA_INSTALL_DIRECTORY</replaceable>
6007 /lib/printers.def</filename></para>
6009 <para>This file is created from Windows 95 <filename>msprint.inf
6010 </filename> files found on the Windows 95 client system. For more
6011 details on setting up serving of printer drivers to Windows 95
6012 clients, see the outdated documentation file in the <filename>docs/</filename>
6013 directory, <filename>PRINTER_DRIVER.txt</filename>.</para>
6015 <para>See also <link linkend="PRINTERDRIVERLOCATION"><parameter>
6016 printer driver location</parameter></link>.</para>
6018 <para>Default: <emphasis>None (set in compile).</emphasis></para>
6020 <para>Example: <command>printer driver file =
6021 /usr/local/samba/printers/drivers.def</command></para>
6022 </listitem>
6023 </varlistentry>
6028 <varlistentry>
6029 <term><anchor id="PRINTERDRIVERLOCATION">printer driver location (S)</term>
6030 <listitem><para><emphasis>Note :</emphasis>This is a deprecated
6031 parameter and will be removed in the next major release
6032 following version 2.2. Please see the instructions in
6033 the <ulink url="printer_driver2.html">Samba 2.2. Printing
6034 HOWTO</ulink> for more information
6035 on the new method of loading printer drivers onto a Samba server.
6036 </para>
6038 <para>This parameter tells clients of a particular printer
6039 share where to find the printer driver files for the automatic
6040 installation of drivers for Windows 95 machines. If Samba is set up
6041 to serve printer drivers to Windows 95 machines, this should be set to</para>
6043 <para><command>\\MACHINE\PRINTER$</command></para>
6045 <para>Where MACHINE is the NetBIOS name of your Samba server,
6046 and PRINTER$ is a share you set up for serving printer driver
6047 files. For more details on setting this up see the outdated documentation
6048 file in the <filename>docs/</filename> directory, <filename>
6049 PRINTER_DRIVER.txt</filename>.</para>
6051 <para>See also <link linkend="PRINTERDRIVERFILE"><parameter>
6052 printer driver file</parameter></link>.</para>
6054 <para>Default: <command>none</command></para>
6055 <para>Example: <command>printer driver location = \\MACHINE\PRINTER$
6056 </command></para>
6057 </listitem>
6058 </varlistentry>
6062 <varlistentry>
6063 <term><anchor id="PRINTERNAME">printer name (S)</term>
6064 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the name of the printer
6065 to which print jobs spooled through a printable service will be sent.</para>
6067 <para>If specified in the [global] section, the printer
6068 name given will be used for any printable service that does
6069 not have its own printer name specified.</para>
6071 <para>Default: <emphasis>none (but may be <constant>lp</constant>
6072 on many systems)</emphasis></para>
6074 <para>Example: <command>printer name = laserwriter</command></para>
6075 </listitem>
6076 </varlistentry>
6079 <varlistentry>
6080 <term><anchor id="PRINTER">printer (S)</term>
6081 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="PRINTERNAME"><parameter>
6082 printer name</parameter></link>.</para>
6083 </listitem>
6084 </varlistentry>
6088 <varlistentry>
6089 <term><anchor id="PRINTING">printing (S)</term>
6090 <listitem><para>This parameters controls how printer status
6091 information is interpreted on your system. It also affects the
6092 default values for the <parameter>print command</parameter>,
6093 <parameter>lpq command</parameter>, <parameter>lppause command
6094 </parameter>, <parameter>lpresume command</parameter>, and
6095 <parameter>lprm command</parameter> if specified in the
6096 [global] section.</para>
6098 <para>Currently nine printing styles are supported. They are
6099 <constant>BSD</constant>, <constant>AIX</constant>,
6100 <constant>LPRNG</constant>, <constant>PLP</constant>,
6101 <constant>SYSV</constant>, <constant>HPUX</constant>,
6102 <constant>QNX</constant>, <constant>SOFTQ</constant>,
6103 and <constant>CUPS</constant>.</para>
6105 <para>To see what the defaults are for the other print
6106 commands when using the various options use the <ulink
6107 url="testparm.1.html">testparm(1)</ulink> program.</para>
6109 <para>This option can be set on a per printer basis</para>
6111 <para>See also the discussion in the <link linkend="PRINTERSSECT">
6112 [printers]</link> section.</para>
6113 </listitem>
6114 </varlistentry>
6119 <varlistentry>
6120 <term><anchor id="PROTOCOL">protocol (G)</term>
6121 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="MAXPROTOCOL">
6122 <parameter>max protocol</parameter></link>.</para></listitem>
6123 </varlistentry>
6128 <varlistentry>
6129 <term><anchor id="PUBLIC">public (S)</term>
6130 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="GUESTOK"><parameter>guest
6131 ok</parameter></link>.</para>
6132 </listitem>
6133 </varlistentry>
6137 <varlistentry>
6138 <term><anchor id="QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND">queuepause command (S)</term>
6139 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be
6140 executed on the server host in order to pause the printer queue.</para>
6142 <para>This command should be a program or script which takes
6143 a printer name as its only parameter and stops the printer queue,
6144 such that no longer jobs are submitted to the printer.</para>
6146 <para>This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups,
6147 but can be issued from the Printers window under Windows 95
6148 and NT.</para>
6150 <para>If a <parameter>%p</parameter> is given then the printer name
6151 is put in its place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the command.
6152 </para>
6154 <para>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute
6155 path in the command as the PATH may not be available to the
6156 server.</para>
6158 <para>Default: <emphasis>depends on the setting of <parameter>printing
6159 </parameter></emphasis></para>
6160 <para>Example: <command>queuepause command = disable %p</command></para>
6161 </listitem>
6162 </varlistentry>
6166 <varlistentry>
6167 <term><anchor id="QUEUERESUMECOMMAND">queueresume command (S)</term>
6168 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the command to be
6169 executed on the server host in order to resume the printer queue. It
6170 is the command to undo the behavior that is caused by the
6171 previous parameter (<link linkend="QUEUEPAUSECOMMAND"><parameter>
6172 queuepause command</parameter></link>).</para>
6174 <para>This command should be a program or script which takes
6175 a printer name as its only parameter and resumes the printer queue,
6176 such that queued jobs are resubmitted to the printer.</para>
6178 <para>This command is not supported by Windows for Workgroups,
6179 but can be issued from the Printers window under Windows 95
6180 and NT.</para>
6182 <para>If a <parameter>%p</parameter> is given then the printer name
6183 is put in its place. Otherwise it is placed at the end of the
6184 command.</para>
6186 <para>Note that it is good practice to include the absolute
6187 path in the command as the PATH may not be available to the
6188 server.</para>
6190 <para>Default: <emphasis>depends on the setting of <link
6191 linkend="PRINTING"><parameter>printing</parameter></link></emphasis>
6192 </para>
6194 <para>Example: <command>queuepause command = enable %p
6195 </command></para>
6196 </listitem>
6197 </varlistentry>
6201 <varlistentry>
6202 <term><anchor id="READBMPX">read bmpx (G)</term>
6203 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether <ulink
6204 url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will support the "Read
6205 Block Multiplex" SMB. This is now rarely used and defaults to
6206 <constant>no</constant>. You should never need to set this
6207 parameter.</para>
6209 <para>Default: <command>read bmpx = no</command></para>
6210 </listitem>
6211 </varlistentry>
6216 <varlistentry>
6217 <term><anchor id="READLIST">read list (S)</term>
6218 <listitem><para>This is a list of users that are given read-only
6219 access to a service. If the connecting user is in this list then
6220 they will not be given write access, no matter what the <link
6221 linkend="WRITEABLE"><parameter>writeable</parameter></link>
6222 option is set to. The list can include group names using the
6223 syntax described in the <link linkend="INVALIDUSERS"><parameter>
6224 invalid users</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
6226 <para>See also the <link linkend="WRITELIST"><parameter>
6227 write list</parameter></link> parameter and the <link
6228 linkend="INVALIDUSERS"><parameter>invalid users</parameter>
6229 </link> parameter.</para>
6231 <para>Default: <command>read list = &lt;empty string&gt;</command></para>
6232 <para>Example: <command>read list = mary, @students</command></para>
6233 </listitem>
6234 </varlistentry>
6238 <varlistentry>
6239 <term><anchor id="READONLY">read only (S)</term>
6240 <listitem><para>Note that this is an inverted synonym for <link
6241 linkend="WRITEABLE"><parameter>writeable</parameter></link>.</para>
6242 </listitem>
6243 </varlistentry>
6247 <varlistentry>
6248 <term><anchor id="READRAW">read raw (G)</term>
6249 <listitem><para>This parameter controls whether or not the server
6250 will support the raw read SMB requests when transferring data
6251 to clients.</para>
6253 <para>If enabled, raw reads allow reads of 65535 bytes in
6254 one packet. This typically provides a major performance benefit.
6255 </para>
6257 <para>However, some clients either negotiate the allowable
6258 block size incorrectly or are incapable of supporting larger block
6259 sizes, and for these clients you may need to disable raw reads.</para>
6261 <para>In general this parameter should be viewed as a system tuning
6262 tool and left severely alone. See also <link linkend="WRITERAW">
6263 <parameter>write raw</parameter></link>.</para>
6265 <para>Default: <command>read raw = yes</command></para>
6266 </listitem>
6267 </varlistentry>
6270 <varlistentry>
6271 <term><anchor id="READSIZE">read size (G)</term>
6272 <listitem><para>The option <parameter>read size</parameter>
6273 affects the overlap of disk reads/writes with network reads/writes.
6274 If the amount of data being transferred in several of the SMB
6275 commands (currently SMBwrite, SMBwriteX and SMBreadbraw) is larger
6276 than this value then the server begins writing the data before it
6277 has received the whole packet from the network, or in the case of
6278 SMBreadbraw, it begins writing to the network before all the data
6279 has been read from disk.</para>
6281 <para>This overlapping works best when the speeds of disk and
6282 network access are similar, having very little effect when the
6283 speed of one is much greater than the other.</para>
6285 <para>The default value is 16384, but very little experimentation
6286 has been done yet to determine the optimal value, and it is likely
6287 that the best value will vary greatly between systems anyway.
6288 A value over 65536 is pointless and will cause you to allocate
6289 memory unnecessarily.</para>
6291 <para>Default: <command>read size = 16384</command></para>
6292 <para>Example: <command>read size = 8192</command></para>
6293 </listitem>
6294 </varlistentry>
6298 <varlistentry>
6299 <term><anchor id="REMOTEANNOUNCE">remote announce (G)</term>
6300 <listitem><para>This option allows you to setup <ulink
6301 url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> to periodically announce itself
6302 to arbitrary IP addresses with an arbitrary workgroup name.</para>
6304 <para>This is useful if you want your Samba server to appear
6305 in a remote workgroup for which the normal browse propagation
6306 rules don't work. The remote workgroup can be anywhere that you
6307 can send IP packets to.</para>
6309 <para>For example:</para>
6311 <para><command>remote announce = 192.168.2.255/SERVERS
6312 192.168.4.255/STAFF</command></para>
6314 <para>the above line would cause <command>nmbd</command> to announce itself
6315 to the two given IP addresses using the given workgroup names.
6316 If you leave out the workgroup name then the one given in
6317 the <link linkend="WORKGROUP"><parameter>workgroup</parameter></link>
6318 parameter is used instead.</para>
6320 <para>The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast
6321 addresses of the remote networks, but can also be the IP addresses
6322 of known browse masters if your network config is that stable.</para>
6324 <para>See the documentation file <filename>BROWSING.txt</filename>
6325 in the <filename>docs/</filename> directory.</para>
6327 <para>Default: <command>remote announce = &lt;empty string&gt;
6328 </command></para>
6329 </listitem>
6330 </varlistentry>
6334 <varlistentry>
6335 <term><anchor id="REMOTEBROWSESYNC">remote browse sync (G)</term>
6336 <listitem><para>This option allows you to setup <ulink
6337 url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> to periodically request
6338 synchronization of browse lists with the master browser of a Samba
6339 server that is on a remote segment. This option will allow you to
6340 gain browse lists for multiple workgroups across routed networks. This
6341 is done in a manner that does not work with any non-Samba servers.</para>
6343 <para>This is useful if you want your Samba server and all local
6344 clients to appear in a remote workgroup for which the normal browse
6345 propagation rules don't work. The remote workgroup can be anywhere
6346 that you can send IP packets to.</para>
6348 <para>For example:</para>
6350 <para><command>remote browse sync = 192.168.2.255 192.168.4.255
6351 </command></para>
6353 <para>the above line would cause <command>nmbd</command> to request
6354 the master browser on the specified subnets or addresses to
6355 synchronize their browse lists with the local server.</para>
6357 <para>The IP addresses you choose would normally be the broadcast
6358 addresses of the remote networks, but can also be the IP addresses
6359 of known browse masters if your network config is that stable. If
6360 a machine IP address is given Samba makes NO attempt to validate
6361 that the remote machine is available, is listening, nor that it
6362 is in fact the browse master on its segment.</para>
6364 <para>Default: <command>remote browse sync = &lt;empty string&gt;
6365 </command></para>
6366 </listitem>
6367 </varlistentry>
6372 <varlistentry>
6373 <term><anchor id="RESTRICTANONYMOUS">restrict anonymous (G)</term>
6374 <listitem><para>This is a boolean parameter. If it is <constant>true</constant>, then
6375 anonymous access to the server will be restricted, namely in the
6376 case where the server is expecting the client to send a username,
6377 but it doesn't. Setting it to <constant>true</constant> will force these anonymous
6378 connections to be denied, and the client will be required to always
6379 supply a username and password when connecting. Use of this parameter
6380 is only recommended for homogeneous NT client environments.</para>
6382 <para>This parameter makes the use of macro expansions that rely
6383 on the username (%U, %G, etc) consistent. NT 4.0
6384 likes to use anonymous connections when refreshing the share list,
6385 and this is a way to work around that.</para>
6387 <para>When restrict anonymous is <constant>true</constant>, all anonymous connections
6388 are denied no matter what they are for. This can effect the ability
6389 of a machine to access the Samba Primary Domain Controller to revalidate
6390 its machine account after someone else has logged on the client
6391 interactively. The NT client will display a message saying that
6392 the machine's account in the domain doesn't exist or the password is
6393 bad. The best way to deal with this is to reboot NT client machines
6394 between interactive logons, using "Shutdown and Restart", rather
6395 than "Close all programs and logon as a different user".</para>
6397 <para>Default: <command>restrict anonymous = no</command></para>
6398 </listitem>
6399 </varlistentry>
6403 <varlistentry>
6404 <term><anchor id="ROOT">root (G)</term>
6405 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="ROOTDIRECTORY">
6406 <parameter>root directory"</parameter></link>.</para>
6407 </listitem>
6408 </varlistentry>
6412 <varlistentry>
6413 <term><anchor id="ROOTDIR">root dir (G)</term>
6414 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="ROOTDIRECTORY">
6415 <parameter>root directory"</parameter></link>.</para>
6416 </listitem>
6417 </varlistentry>
6420 <varlistentry>
6421 <term><anchor id="ROOTDIRECTORY">root directory (G)</term>
6422 <listitem><para>The server will <command>chroot()</command> (i.e.
6423 Change its root directory) to this directory on startup. This is
6424 not strictly necessary for secure operation. Even without it the
6425 server will deny access to files not in one of the service entries.
6426 It may also check for, and deny access to, soft links to other
6427 parts of the filesystem, or attempts to use ".." in file names
6428 to access other directories (depending on the setting of the <link
6429 linkend="WIDELINKS"><parameter>wide links</parameter></link>
6430 parameter).</para>
6432 <para>Adding a <parameter>root directory</parameter> entry other
6433 than "/" adds an extra level of security, but at a price. It
6434 absolutely ensures that no access is given to files not in the
6435 sub-tree specified in the <parameter>root directory</parameter>
6436 option, <emphasis>including</emphasis> some files needed for
6437 complete operation of the server. To maintain full operability
6438 of the server you will need to mirror some system files
6439 into the <parameter>root directory</parameter> tree. In particular
6440 you will need to mirror <filename>/etc/passwd</filename> (or a
6441 subset of it), and any binaries or configuration files needed for
6442 printing (if required). The set of files that must be mirrored is
6443 operating system dependent.</para>
6445 <para>Default: <command>root directory = /</command></para>
6446 <para>Example: <command>root directory = /homes/smb</command></para>
6447 </listitem>
6448 </varlistentry>
6452 <varlistentry>
6453 <term><anchor id="ROOTPOSTEXEC">root postexec (S)</term>
6454 <listitem><para>This is the same as the <parameter>postexec</parameter>
6455 parameter except that the command is run as root. This
6456 is useful for unmounting filesystems
6457 (such as CDROMs) after a connection is closed.</para>
6459 <para>See also <link linkend="POSTEXEC"><parameter>
6460 postexec</parameter></link>.</para>
6462 <para>Default: <command>root postexec = &lt;empty string&gt;
6463 </command></para>
6464 </listitem>
6465 </varlistentry>
6467 <varlistentry>
6468 <term><anchor id="ROOTPREEXEC">root preexec (S)</term>
6469 <listitem><para>This is the same as the <parameter>preexec</parameter>
6470 parameter except that the command is run as root. This
6471 is useful for mounting filesystems (such as CDROMs) when a
6472 connection is opened.</para>
6474 <para>See also <link linkend="PREEXEC"><parameter>
6475 preexec</parameter></link> and <link linkend="PREEXECCLOSE">
6476 <parameter>preexec close</parameter></link>.</para>
6478 <para>Default: <command>root preexec = &lt;empty string&gt;
6479 </command></para>
6480 </listitem>
6481 </varlistentry>
6485 <varlistentry>
6486 <term><anchor id="ROOTPREEXECCLOSE">root preexec close (S)</term>
6487 <listitem><para>This is the same as the <parameter>preexec close
6488 </parameter> parameter except that the command is run as root.</para>
6490 <para>See also <link linkend="PREEXEC"><parameter>
6491 preexec</parameter></link> and <link linkend="PREEXECCLOSE">
6492 <parameter>preexec close</parameter></link>.</para>
6494 <para>Default: <command>root preexec close = no</command></para>
6495 </listitem>
6496 </varlistentry>
6499 <varlistentry>
6500 <term><anchor id="SECURITY">security (G)</term>
6501 <listitem><para>This option affects how clients respond to
6502 Samba and is one of the most important settings in the <filename>
6503 smb.conf</filename> file.</para>
6505 <para>The option sets the "security mode bit" in replies to
6506 protocol negotiations with <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)
6507 </ulink> to turn share level security on or off. Clients decide
6508 based on this bit whether (and how) to transfer user and password
6509 information to the server.</para>
6512 <para>The default is <command>security = user</command>, as this is
6513 the most common setting needed when talking to Windows 98 and
6514 Windows NT.</para>
6516 <para>The alternatives are <command>security = share</command>,
6517 <command>security = server</command> or <command>security = domain
6518 </command>.</para>
6520 <para>In versions of Samba prior to 2.0.0, the default was
6521 <command>security = share</command> mainly because that was
6522 the only option at one stage.</para>
6524 <para>There is a bug in WfWg that has relevance to this
6525 setting. When in user or server level security a WfWg client
6526 will totally ignore the password you type in the "connect
6527 drive" dialog box. This makes it very difficult (if not impossible)
6528 to connect to a Samba service as anyone except the user that
6529 you are logged into WfWg as.</para>
6531 <para>If your PCs use usernames that are the same as their
6532 usernames on the UNIX machine then you will want to use
6533 <command>security = user</command>. If you mostly use usernames
6534 that don't exist on the UNIX box then use <command>security =
6535 share</command>.</para>
6537 <para>You should also use <command>security = share</command> if you
6538 want to mainly setup shares without a password (guest shares). This
6539 is commonly used for a shared printer server. It is more difficult
6540 to setup guest shares with <command>security = user</command>, see
6541 the <link linkend="MAPTOGUEST"><parameter>map to guest</parameter>
6542 </link>parameter for details.</para>
6544 <para>It is possible to use <command>smbd</command> in a <emphasis>
6545 hybrid mode</emphasis> where it is offers both user and share
6546 level security under different <link linkend="NETBIOSALIASES">
6547 <parameter>NetBIOS aliases</parameter></link>. </para>
6549 <para>The different settings will now be explained.</para>
6552 <para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSSHARE"><emphasis>SECURITY = SHARE
6553 </emphasis></para>
6555 <para>When clients connect to a share level security server they
6556 need not log onto the server with a valid username and password before
6557 attempting to connect to a shared resource (although modern clients
6558 such as Windows 95/98 and Windows NT will send a logon request with
6559 a username but no password when talking to a <command>security = share
6560 </command> server). Instead, the clients send authentication information
6561 (passwords) on a per-share basis, at the time they attempt to connect
6562 to that share.</para>
6564 <para>Note that <command>smbd</command> <emphasis>ALWAYS</emphasis>
6565 uses a valid UNIX user to act on behalf of the client, even in
6566 <command>security = share</command> level security.</para>
6568 <para>As clients are not required to send a username to the server
6569 in share level security, <command>smbd</command> uses several
6570 techniques to determine the correct UNIX user to use on behalf
6571 of the client.</para>
6573 <para>A list of possible UNIX usernames to match with the given
6574 client password is constructed using the following methods :</para>
6576 <itemizedlist>
6577 <listitem><para>If the <link linkend="GUESTONLY"><parameter>guest
6578 only</parameter></link> parameter is set, then all the other
6579 stages are missed and only the <link linkend="GUESTACCOUNT">
6580 <parameter>guest account</parameter></link> username is checked.
6581 </para></listitem>
6583 <listitem><para>Is a username is sent with the share connection
6584 request, then this username (after mapping - see <link
6585 linkend="USERNAMEMAP"><parameter>username map</parameter></link>),
6586 is added as a potential username.</para></listitem>
6588 <listitem><para>If the client did a previous <emphasis>logon
6589 </emphasis> request (the SessionSetup SMB call) then the
6590 username sent in this SMB will be added as a potential username.
6591 </para></listitem>
6593 <listitem><para>The name of the service the client requested is
6594 added as a potential username.</para></listitem>
6596 <listitem><para>The NetBIOS name of the client is added to
6597 the list as a potential username.</para></listitem>
6599 <listitem><para>Any users on the <link linkend="USER"><parameter>
6600 user</parameter></link> list are added as potential usernames.
6601 </para></listitem>
6602 </itemizedlist>
6604 <para>If the <parameter>guest only</parameter> parameter is
6605 not set, then this list is then tried with the supplied password.
6606 The first user for whom the password matches will be used as the
6607 UNIX user.</para>
6609 <para>If the <parameter>guest only</parameter> parameter is
6610 set, or no username can be determined then if the share is marked
6611 as available to the <parameter>guest account</parameter>, then this
6612 guest user will be used, otherwise access is denied.</para>
6614 <para>Note that it can be <emphasis>very</emphasis> confusing
6615 in share-level security as to which UNIX username will eventually
6616 be used in granting access.</para>
6618 <para>See also the section <link linkend="VALIDATIONSECT">
6619 NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</link>.</para>
6621 <para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSUSER"><emphasis>SECURITY = USER
6622 </emphasis></para>
6624 <para>This is the default security setting in Samba 2.2.
6625 With user-level security a client must first "log-on" with a
6626 valid username and password (which can be mapped using the <link
6627 linkend="USERNAMEMAP"><parameter>username map</parameter></link>
6628 parameter). Encrypted passwords (see the <link linkend="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS">
6629 <parameter>encrypted passwords</parameter></link> parameter) can also
6630 be used in this security mode. Parameters such as <link linkend="USER">
6631 <parameter>user</parameter></link> and <link linkend="GUESTONLY">
6632 <parameter>guest only</parameter></link> if set are then applied and
6633 may change the UNIX user to use on this connection, but only after
6634 the user has been successfully authenticated.</para>
6636 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that the name of the resource being
6637 requested is <emphasis>not</emphasis> sent to the server until after
6638 the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why
6639 guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing
6640 the server to automatically map unknown users into the <link
6641 linkend="GUESTACCOUNT"><parameter>guest account</parameter></link>.
6642 See the <link linkend="MAPTOGUEST"><parameter>map to guest</parameter>
6643 </link> parameter for details on doing this.</para>
6645 <para>See also the section <link linkend="VALIDATIONSECT">
6646 NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</link>.</para>
6648 <para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSSERVER"><emphasis>SECURITY = SERVER
6649 </emphasis></para>
6651 <para>In this mode Samba will try to validate the username/password
6652 by passing it to another SMB server, such as an NT box. If this
6653 fails it will revert to <command>security = user</command>, but note
6654 that if encrypted passwords have been negotiated then Samba cannot
6655 revert back to checking the UNIX password file, it must have a valid
6656 <filename>smbpasswd</filename> file to check users against. See the
6657 documentation file in the <filename>docs/</filename> directory
6658 <filename>ENCRYPTION.txt</filename> for details on how to set this
6659 up.</para>
6661 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that from the client's point of
6662 view <command>security = server</command> is the same as <command>
6663 security = user</command>. It only affects how the server deals
6664 with the authentication, it does not in any way affect what the
6665 client sees.</para>
6667 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that the name of the resource being
6668 requested is <emphasis>not</emphasis> sent to the server until after
6669 the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why
6670 guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing
6671 the server to automatically map unknown users into the <link
6672 linkend="GUESTACCOUNT"><parameter>guest account</parameter></link>.
6673 See the <link linkend="MAPTOGUEST"><parameter>map to guest</parameter>
6674 </link> parameter for details on doing this.</para>
6676 <para>See also the section <link linkend="VALIDATIONSECT">
6677 NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</link>.</para>
6679 <para>See also the <link linkend="PASSWORDSERVER"><parameter>password
6680 server</parameter></link> parameter and the <link
6681 linkend="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"><parameter>encrypted passwords</parameter>
6682 </link> parameter.</para>
6684 <para><anchor id="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"><emphasis>SECURITY = DOMAIN
6685 </emphasis></para>
6687 <para>This mode will only work correctly if <ulink
6688 url="smbpasswd.8.html">smbpasswd(8)</ulink> has been used to add this
6689 machine into a Windows NT Domain. It expects the <link
6690 linkend="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"><parameter>encrypted passwords</parameter>
6691 </link> parameter to be set to <constant>true</constant>. In this
6692 mode Samba will try to validate the username/password by passing
6693 it to a Windows NT Primary or Backup Domain Controller, in exactly
6694 the same way that a Windows NT Server would do.</para>
6696 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that a valid UNIX user must still
6697 exist as well as the account on the Domain Controller to allow
6698 Samba to have a valid UNIX account to map file access to.</para>
6700 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that from the client's point
6701 of view <command>security = domain</command> is the same as <command>security = user
6702 </command>. It only affects how the server deals with the authentication,
6703 it does not in any way affect what the client sees.</para>
6705 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that the name of the resource being
6706 requested is <emphasis>not</emphasis> sent to the server until after
6707 the server has successfully authenticated the client. This is why
6708 guest shares don't work in user level security without allowing
6709 the server to automatically map unknown users into the <link
6710 linkend="GUESTACCOUNT"><parameter>guest account</parameter></link>.
6711 See the <link linkend="MAPTOGUEST"><parameter>map to guest</parameter>
6712 </link> parameter for details on doing this.</para>
6714 <para><emphasis>BUG:</emphasis> There is currently a bug in the
6715 implementation of <command>security = domain</command> with respect
6716 to multi-byte character set usernames. The communication with a
6717 Domain Controller must be done in UNICODE and Samba currently
6718 does not widen multi-byte user names to UNICODE correctly, thus
6719 a multi-byte username will not be recognized correctly at the
6720 Domain Controller. This issue will be addressed in a future release.</para>
6722 <para>See also the section <link linkend="VALIDATIONSECT">
6723 NOTE ABOUT USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</link>.</para>
6725 <para>See also the <link linkend="PASSWORDSERVER"><parameter>password
6726 server</parameter></link> parameter and the <link
6727 linkend="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"><parameter>encrypted passwords</parameter>
6728 </link> parameter.</para>
6730 <para>Default: <command>security = USER</command></para>
6731 <para>Example: <command>security = DOMAIN</command></para>
6732 </listitem>
6733 </varlistentry>
6737 <varlistentry>
6738 <term><anchor id="SECURITYMASK">security mask (S)</term>
6739 <listitem><para>This parameter controls what UNIX permission
6740 bits can be modified when a Windows NT client is manipulating
6741 the UNIX permission on a file using the native NT security
6742 dialog box.</para>
6744 <para>This parameter is applied as a mask (AND'ed with) to
6745 the changed permission bits, thus preventing any bits not in
6746 this mask from being modified. Essentially, zero bits in this
6747 mask may be treated as a set of bits the user is not allowed
6748 to change.</para>
6750 <para>If not set explicitly this parameter is 0777, allowing
6751 a user to modify all the user/group/world permissions on a file.
6752 </para>
6754 <para><emphasis>Note</emphasis> that users who can access the
6755 Samba server through other means can easily bypass this
6756 restriction, so it is primarily useful for standalone
6757 "appliance" systems. Administrators of most normal systems will
6758 probably want to leave it set to <constant>0777</constant>.</para>
6760 <para>See also the <link linkend="FORCEDIRECTORYSECURITYMODE">
6761 <parameter>force directory security mode</parameter></link>,
6762 <link linkend="DIRECTORYSECURITYMASK"><parameter>directory
6763 security mask</parameter></link>, <link linkend="FORCESECURITYMODE">
6764 <parameter>force security mode</parameter></link> parameters.</para>
6766 <para>Default: <command>security mask = 0777</command></para>
6767 <para>Example: <command>security mask = 0770</command></para>
6768 </listitem>
6769 </varlistentry>
6772 <varlistentry>
6773 <term><anchor id="SERVERSTRING">server string (G)</term>
6774 <listitem><para>This controls what string will show up in the
6775 printer comment box in print manager and next to the IPC connection
6776 in <command>net view</command>. It can be any string that you wish
6777 to show to your users.</para>
6779 <para>It also sets what will appear in browse lists next
6780 to the machine name.</para>
6782 <para>A <parameter>%v</parameter> will be replaced with the Samba
6783 version number.</para>
6785 <para>A <parameter>%h</parameter> will be replaced with the
6786 hostname.</para>
6788 <para>Default: <command>server string = Samba %v</command></para>
6790 <para>Example: <command>server string = University of GNUs Samba
6791 Server</command></para>
6792 </listitem>
6793 </varlistentry>
6797 <varlistentry>
6798 <term><anchor id="SETDIRECTORY">set directory (S)</term>
6799 <listitem><para>If <command>set directory = no</command>, then
6800 users of the service may not use the setdir command to change
6801 directory.</para>
6803 <para>The <command>setdir</command> command is only implemented
6804 in the Digital Pathworks client. See the Pathworks documentation
6805 for details.</para>
6807 <para>Default: <command>set directory = no</command></para>
6808 </listitem>
6809 </varlistentry>
6813 <varlistentry>
6814 <term><anchor id="SHAREMODES">share modes (S)</term>
6815 <listitem><para>This enables or disables the honoring of
6816 the <parameter>share modes</parameter> during a file open. These
6817 modes are used by clients to gain exclusive read or write access
6818 to a file.</para>
6820 <para>These open modes are not directly supported by UNIX, so
6821 they are simulated using shared memory, or lock files if your
6822 UNIX doesn't support shared memory (almost all do).</para>
6824 <para>The share modes that are enabled by this option are
6825 <constant>DENY_DOS</constant>, <constant>DENY_ALL</constant>,
6826 <constant>DENY_READ</constant>, <constant>DENY_WRITE</constant>,
6827 <constant>DENY_NONE</constant> and <constant>DENY_FCB</constant>.
6828 </para>
6830 <para>This option gives full share compatibility and enabled
6831 by default.</para>
6833 <para>You should <emphasis>NEVER</emphasis> turn this parameter
6834 off as many Windows applications will break if you do so.</para>
6836 <para>Default: <command>share modes = yes</command></para>
6837 </listitem>
6838 </varlistentry>
6842 <varlistentry>
6843 <term><anchor id="SHORTPRESERVECASE">short preserve case (S)</term>
6844 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls if new files
6845 which conform to 8.3 syntax, that is all in upper case and of
6846 suitable length, are created upper case, or if they are forced
6847 to be the <link linkend="DEFAULTCASE"><parameter>default case
6848 </parameter></link>. This option can be use with <link
6849 linkend="PRESERVECASE"><command>preserve case = yes</command>
6850 </link> to permit long filenames to retain their case, while short
6851 names are lowered. </para>
6853 <para>See the section on <link linkend="NAMEMANGLINGSECT">
6854 NAME MANGLING</link>.</para>
6856 <para>Default: <command>short preserve case = yes</command></para>
6857 </listitem>
6858 </varlistentry>
6862 <varlistentry>
6863 <term><anchor id="SHOWADDPRINTERWIZARD">show add printer wizard (G)</term>
6864 <listitem><para>With the introduction of MS-RPC based printing support
6865 for Windows NT/2000 client in Samba 2.2, a "Printers..." folder will
6866 appear on Samba hosts in the share listing. Normally this folder will
6867 contain an icon for the MS Add Printer Wizard (APW). However, it is
6868 possible to disable this feature regardless of the level of privilege
6869 of the connected user.</para>
6871 <para>Under normal circumstances, the Windows NT/2000 client will
6872 open a handle on the printer server with OpenPrinterEx() asking for
6873 Administrator privileges. If the user does not have administrative
6874 access on the print server (i.e is not root or a member of the
6875 <parameter>printer admin</parameter> group), the OpenPrinterEx()
6876 call fails and the client makes another open call with a request for
6877 a lower privilege level. This should succeed, however the APW
6878 icon will not be displayed.</para>
6880 <para>Disabling the <parameter>show add printer wizard</parameter>
6881 parameter will always cause the OpenPrinterEx() on the server
6882 to fail. Thus the APW icon will never be displayed. <emphasis>
6883 Note :</emphasis>This does not prevent the same user from having
6884 administrative privilege on an individual printer.</para>
6886 <para>See also <link linkend="ADDPRINTERCOMMAND"><parameter>addprinter
6887 command</parameter></link>, <link linkend="DELETEPRINTERCOMMAND">
6888 <parameter>deleteprinter command</parameter></link>, <link
6889 linkend="PRINTERADMIN"><parameter>printer admin</parameter></link></para>
6891 <para>Default :<command>show add printer wizard = yes</command></para>
6892 </listitem>
6893 </varlistentry>
6898 <varlistentry>
6899 <term><anchor id="SMBPASSWDFILE">smb passwd file (G)</term>
6900 <listitem><para>This option sets the path to the encrypted
6901 smbpasswd file. By default the path to the smbpasswd file
6902 is compiled into Samba.</para>
6904 <para>Default: <command>smb passwd file = ${prefix}/private/smbpasswd
6905 </command></para>
6907 <para>Example: <command>smb passwd file = /etc/samba/smbpasswd
6908 </command></para>
6909 </listitem>
6910 </varlistentry>
6915 <varlistentry>
6916 <term><anchor id="SOCKETADDRESS">socket address (G)</term>
6917 <listitem><para>This option allows you to control what
6918 address Samba will listen for connections on. This is used to
6919 support multiple virtual interfaces on the one server, each
6920 with a different configuration.</para>
6922 <para>By default Samba will accept connections on any
6923 address.</para>
6925 <para>Example: <command>socket address = 192.168.2.20</command>
6926 </para>
6927 </listitem>
6928 </varlistentry>
6932 <varlistentry>
6933 <term><anchor id="SOCKETOPTIONS">socket options (G)</term>
6934 <listitem><para>This option allows you to set socket options
6935 to be used when talking with the client.</para>
6937 <para>Socket options are controls on the networking layer
6938 of the operating systems which allow the connection to be
6939 tuned.</para>
6941 <para>This option will typically be used to tune your Samba
6942 server for optimal performance for your local network. There is
6943 no way that Samba can know what the optimal parameters are for
6944 your net, so you must experiment and choose them yourself. We
6945 strongly suggest you read the appropriate documentation for your
6946 operating system first (perhaps <command>man setsockopt</command>
6947 will help).</para>
6949 <para>You may find that on some systems Samba will say
6950 "Unknown socket option" when you supply an option. This means you
6951 either incorrectly typed it or you need to add an include file
6952 to includes.h for your OS. If the latter is the case please
6953 send the patch to <ulink url="mailto:samba@samba.org">
6954 samba@samba.org</ulink>.</para>
6956 <para>Any of the supported socket options may be combined
6957 in any way you like, as long as your OS allows it.</para>
6959 <para>This is the list of socket options currently settable
6960 using this option:</para>
6962 <itemizedlist>
6963 <listitem><para>SO_KEEPALIVE</para></listitem>
6964 <listitem><para>SO_REUSEADDR</para></listitem>
6965 <listitem><para>SO_BROADCAST</para></listitem>
6966 <listitem><para>TCP_NODELAY</para></listitem>
6967 <listitem><para>IPTOS_LOWDELAY</para></listitem>
6968 <listitem><para>IPTOS_THROUGHPUT</para></listitem>
6969 <listitem><para>SO_SNDBUF *</para></listitem>
6970 <listitem><para>SO_RCVBUF *</para></listitem>
6971 <listitem><para>SO_SNDLOWAT *</para></listitem>
6972 <listitem><para>SO_RCVLOWAT *</para></listitem>
6973 </itemizedlist>
6975 <para>Those marked with a <emphasis>'*'</emphasis> take an integer
6976 argument. The others can optionally take a 1 or 0 argument to enable
6977 or disable the option, by default they will be enabled if you
6978 don't specify 1 or 0.</para>
6980 <para>To specify an argument use the syntax SOME_OPTION = VALUE
6981 for example <command>SO_SNDBUF = 8192</command>. Note that you must
6982 not have any spaces before or after the = sign.</para>
6984 <para>If you are on a local network then a sensible option
6985 might be</para>
6986 <para><command>socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY</command></para>
6988 <para>If you have a local network then you could try:</para>
6989 <para><command>socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY TCP_NODELAY</command></para>
6991 <para>If you are on a wide area network then perhaps try
6992 setting IPTOS_THROUGHPUT. </para>
6994 <para>Note that several of the options may cause your Samba
6995 server to fail completely. Use these options with caution!</para>
6997 <para>Default: <command>socket options = TCP_NODELAY</command></para>
6998 <para>Example: <command>socket options = IPTOS_LOWDELAY</command></para>
6999 </listitem>
7000 </varlistentry>
7005 <varlistentry>
7006 <term><anchor id="SOURCEENVIRONMENT">source environment (G)</term>
7007 <listitem><para>This parameter causes Samba to set environment
7008 variables as per the content of the file named.</para>
7010 <para>If the value of this parameter starts with a "|" character
7011 then Samba will treat that value as a pipe command to open and
7012 will set the environment variables from the output of the pipe.</para>
7014 <para>The contents of the file or the output of the pipe should
7015 be formatted as the output of the standard Unix <command>env(1)
7016 </command> command. This is of the form :</para>
7017 <para>Example environment entry:</para>
7018 <para><command>SAMBA_NETBIOS_NAME = myhostname</command></para>
7020 <para>Default: <emphasis>No default value</emphasis></para>
7021 <para>Examples: <command>source environment = |/etc/smb.conf.sh
7022 </command></para>
7024 <para>Example: <command>source environment =
7025 /usr/local/smb_env_vars</command></para>
7026 </listitem>
7027 </varlistentry>
7031 <varlistentry>
7032 <term><anchor id="SSL">ssl (G)</term>
7033 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7034 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7035 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7036 given at configure time.</para>
7038 <para>This variable enables or disables the entire SSL mode. If
7039 it is set to <constant>no</constant>, the SSL-enabled Samba behaves
7040 exactly like the non-SSL Samba. If set to <constant>yes</constant>,
7041 it depends on the variables <link linkend="SSLHOSTS"><parameter>
7042 ssl hosts</parameter></link> and <link linkend="SSLHOSTSRESIGN">
7043 <parameter>ssl hosts resign</parameter></link> whether an SSL
7044 connection will be required.</para>
7046 <para>Default: <command>ssl = no</command></para>
7047 </listitem>
7048 </varlistentry>
7052 <varlistentry>
7053 <term><anchor id="SSLCACERTDIR">ssl CA certDir (G)</term>
7054 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7055 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7056 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7057 given at configure time.</para>
7059 <para>This variable defines where to look up the Certification
7060 Authorities. The given directory should contain one file for
7061 each CA that Samba will trust. The file name must be the hash
7062 value over the "Distinguished Name" of the CA. How this directory
7063 is set up is explained later in this document. All files within the
7064 directory that don't fit into this naming scheme are ignored. You
7065 don't need this variable if you don't verify client certificates.</para>
7067 <para>Default: <command>ssl CA certDir = /usr/local/ssl/certs
7068 </command></para>
7069 </listitem>
7070 </varlistentry>
7074 <varlistentry>
7075 <term><anchor id="SSLCACERTFILE">ssl CA certFile (G)</term>
7076 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7077 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7078 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7079 given at configure time.</para>
7081 <para>This variable is a second way to define the trusted CAs.
7082 The certificates of the trusted CAs are collected in one big
7083 file and this variable points to the file. You will probably
7084 only use one of the two ways to define your CAs. The first choice is
7085 preferable if you have many CAs or want to be flexible, the second
7086 is preferable if you only have one CA and want to keep things
7087 simple (you won't need to create the hashed file names). You
7088 don't need this variable if you don't verify client certificates.</para>
7090 <para>Default: <command>ssl CA certFile = /usr/local/ssl/certs/trustedCAs.pem
7091 </command></para>
7092 </listitem>
7093 </varlistentry>
7097 <varlistentry>
7098 <term><anchor id="SSLCIPHERS">ssl ciphers (G)</term>
7099 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7100 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7101 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7102 given at configure time.</para>
7104 <para>This variable defines the ciphers that should be offered
7105 during SSL negotiation. You should not set this variable unless
7106 you know what you are doing.</para>
7107 </listitem>
7108 </varlistentry>
7111 <varlistentry>
7112 <term><anchor id="SSLCLIENTCERT">ssl client cert (G)</term>
7113 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7114 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7115 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7116 given at configure time.</para>
7118 <para>The certificate in this file is used by <ulink url="smbclient.1.html">
7119 <command>smbclient(1)</command></ulink> if it exists. It's needed
7120 if the server requires a client certificate.</para>
7122 <para>Default: <command>ssl client cert = /usr/local/ssl/certs/smbclient.pem
7123 </command></para>
7124 </listitem>
7125 </varlistentry>
7129 <varlistentry>
7130 <term><anchor id="SSLCLIENTKEY">ssl client key (G)</term>
7131 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7132 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7133 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7134 given at configure time.</para>
7136 <para>This is the private key for <ulink url="smbclient.1.html">
7137 <command>smbclient(1)</command></ulink>. It's only needed if the
7138 client should have a certificate. </para>
7140 <para>Default: <command>ssl client key = /usr/local/ssl/private/smbclient.pem
7141 </command></para>
7142 </listitem>
7143 </varlistentry>
7147 <varlistentry>
7148 <term><anchor id="SSLCOMPATIBILITY">ssl compatibility (G)</term>
7149 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7150 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7151 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7152 given at configure time.</para>
7154 <para>This variable defines whether OpenSSL should be configured
7155 for bug compatibility with other SSL implementations. This is
7156 probably not desirable because currently no clients with SSL
7157 implementations other than OpenSSL exist.</para>
7159 <para>Default: <command>ssl compatibility = no</command></para>
7160 </listitem>
7161 </varlistentry>
7164 <varlistentry>
7165 <term><anchor id="SSLEGDSOCKET">ssl egd socket (G)</term>
7166 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7167 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7168 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7169 given at configure time.</para>
7171 <para>
7172 This option is used to define the location of the communiation socket of
7173 an EGD or PRNGD daemon, from which entropy can be retrieved. This option
7174 can be used instead of or together with the <link
7175 linkend="SSLENTROPYFILE"><parameter>ssl entropy file</parameter></link>
7176 directive. 255 bytes of entropy will be retrieved from the daemon.
7177 </para>
7179 <para>Default: <emphasis>none</emphasis></para>
7180 </listitem>
7181 </varlistentry>
7184 <varlistentry>
7185 <term><anchor id="SSLENTROPYBYTES">ssl entropy bytes (G)</term>
7186 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7187 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7188 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7189 given at configure time.</para>
7191 <para>
7192 This parameter is used to define the number of bytes which should
7193 be read from the <link linkend="SSLENTROPYFILE"><parameter>ssl entropy
7194 file</parameter></link> If a -1 is specified, the entire file will
7195 be read.
7196 </para>
7198 <para>Default: <command>ssl entropy bytes = 255</command></para>
7199 </listitem>
7200 </varlistentry>
7204 <varlistentry>
7205 <term><anchor id="SSLENTROPYFILE">ssl entropy file (G)</term>
7206 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7207 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7208 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7209 given at configure time.</para>
7211 <para>
7212 This parameter is used to specify a file from which processes will
7213 read "random bytes" on startup. In order to seed the internal pseudo
7214 random number generator, entropy must be provided. On system with a
7215 <filename>/dev/urandom</filename> device file, the processes
7216 will retrieve its entropy from the kernel. On systems without kernel
7217 entropy support, a file can be supplied that will be read on startup
7218 and that will be used to seed the PRNG.
7219 </para>
7221 <para>Default: <emphasis>none</emphasis></para>
7222 </listitem>
7223 </varlistentry>
7227 <varlistentry>
7228 <term><anchor id="SSLHOSTS">ssl hosts (G)</term>
7229 <listitem><para>See <link linkend="SSLHOSTSRESIGN"><parameter>
7230 ssl hosts resign</parameter></link>.</para>
7231 </listitem>
7232 </varlistentry>
7235 <varlistentry>
7236 <term><anchor id="SSLHOSTSRESIGN">ssl hosts resign (G)</term>
7237 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7238 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7239 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7240 given at configure time.</para>
7242 <para>These two variables define whether Samba will go
7243 into SSL mode or not. If none of them is defined, Samba will
7244 allow only SSL connections. If the <link linkend="SSLHOSTS">
7245 <parameter>ssl hosts</parameter></link> variable lists
7246 hosts (by IP-address, IP-address range, net group or name),
7247 only these hosts will be forced into SSL mode. If the <parameter>
7248 ssl hosts resign</parameter> variable lists hosts, only these
7249 hosts will <emphasis>NOT</emphasis> be forced into SSL mode. The syntax for these two
7250 variables is the same as for the <link linkend="HOSTSALLOW"><parameter>
7251 hosts allow</parameter></link> and <link linkend="HOSTSDENY">
7252 <parameter>hosts deny</parameter></link> pair of variables, only
7253 that the subject of the decision is different: It's not the access
7254 right but whether SSL is used or not. </para>
7256 <para>The example below requires SSL connections from all hosts
7257 outside the local net (which is 192.168.*.*).</para>
7259 <para>Default: <command>ssl hosts = &lt;empty string&gt;</command></para>
7260 <para><command>ssl hosts resign = &lt;empty string&gt;</command></para>
7262 <para>Example: <command>ssl hosts resign = 192.168.</command></para>
7263 </listitem>
7264 </varlistentry>
7268 <varlistentry>
7269 <term><anchor id="SSLREQUIRECLIENTCERT">ssl require clientcert (G)</term>
7270 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7271 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7272 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7273 given at configure time.</para>
7275 <para>If this variable is set to <constant>yes</constant>, the
7276 server will not tolerate connections from clients that don't
7277 have a valid certificate. The directory/file given in <link
7278 linkend="SSLCACERTDIR"><parameter>ssl CA certDir</parameter>
7279 </link> and <link linkend="SSLCACERTFILE"><parameter>ssl CA certFile
7280 </parameter></link> will be used to look up the CAs that issued
7281 the client's certificate. If the certificate can't be verified
7282 positively, the connection will be terminated. If this variable
7283 is set to <constant>no</constant>, clients don't need certificates.
7284 Contrary to web applications you really <emphasis>should</emphasis>
7285 require client certificates. In the web environment the client's
7286 data is sensitive (credit card numbers) and the server must prove
7287 to be trustworthy. In a file server environment the server's data
7288 will be sensitive and the clients must prove to be trustworthy.</para>
7290 <para>Default: <command>ssl require clientcert = no</command></para>
7291 </listitem>
7292 </varlistentry>
7296 <varlistentry>
7297 <term><anchor id="SSLREQUIRESERVERCERT">ssl require servercert (G)</term>
7298 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7299 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7300 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7301 given at configure time.</para>
7303 <para>If this variable is set to <constant>yes</constant>, the
7304 <ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1)</command>
7305 </ulink> will request a certificate from the server. Same as
7306 <link linkend="SSLREQUIRECLIENTCERT"><parameter>ssl require
7307 clientcert</parameter></link> for the server.</para>
7309 <para>Default: <command>ssl require servercert = no</command>
7310 </para>
7311 </listitem>
7312 </varlistentry>
7314 <varlistentry>
7315 <term><anchor id="SSLSERVERCERT">ssl server cert (G)</term>
7316 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7317 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7318 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7319 given at configure time.</para>
7321 <para>This is the file containing the server's certificate.
7322 The server <emphasis>must</emphasis> have a certificate. The
7323 file may also contain the server's private key. See later for
7324 how certificates and private keys are created.</para>
7326 <para>Default: <command>ssl server cert = &lt;empty string&gt;
7327 </command></para>
7328 </listitem>
7329 </varlistentry>
7332 <varlistentry>
7333 <term><anchor id="SSLSERVERKEY">ssl server key (G)</term>
7334 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7335 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7336 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7337 given at configure time.</para>
7339 <para>This file contains the private key of the server. If
7340 this variable is not defined, the key is looked up in the
7341 certificate file (it may be appended to the certificate).
7342 The server <emphasis>must</emphasis> have a private key
7343 and the certificate <emphasis>must</emphasis>
7344 match this private key.</para>
7346 <para>Default: <command>ssl server key = &lt;empty string&gt;
7347 </command></para>
7348 </listitem>
7349 </varlistentry>
7352 <varlistentry>
7353 <term><anchor id="SSLVERSION">ssl version (G)</term>
7354 <listitem><para>This variable is part of SSL-enabled Samba. This
7355 is only available if the SSL libraries have been compiled on your
7356 system and the configure option <command>--with-ssl</command> was
7357 given at configure time.</para>
7359 <para>This enumeration variable defines the versions of the
7360 SSL protocol that will be used. <constant>ssl2or3</constant> allows
7361 dynamic negotiation of SSL v2 or v3, <constant>ssl2</constant> results
7362 in SSL v2, <constant>ssl3</constant> results in SSL v3 and
7363 <constant>tls1</constant> results in TLS v1. TLS (Transport Layer
7364 Security) is the new standard for SSL.</para>
7366 <para>Default: <command>ssl version = "ssl2or3"</command></para>
7367 </listitem>
7368 </varlistentry>
7372 <varlistentry>
7373 <term><anchor id="STATCACHE">stat cache (G)</term>
7374 <listitem><para>This parameter determines if <ulink
7375 url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)</ulink> will use a cache in order to
7376 speed up case insensitive name mappings. You should never need
7377 to change this parameter.</para>
7379 <para>Default: <command>stat cache = yes</command></para>
7380 </listitem>
7381 </varlistentry>
7383 <varlistentry>
7384 <term><anchor id="STATCACHESIZE">stat cache size (G)</term>
7385 <listitem><para>This parameter determines the number of
7386 entries in the <parameter>stat cache</parameter>. You should
7387 never need to change this parameter.</para>
7389 <para>Default: <command>stat cache size = 50</command></para>
7390 </listitem>
7391 </varlistentry>
7395 <varlistentry>
7396 <term><anchor id="STATUS">status (G)</term>
7397 <listitem><para>This enables or disables logging of connections
7398 to a status file that <ulink url="smbstatus.1.html">smbstatus(1)</ulink>
7399 can read.</para>
7401 <para>With this disabled <command>smbstatus</command> won't be able
7402 to tell you what connections are active. You should never need to
7403 change this parameter.</para>
7405 <para>Default: <command>status = yes</command></para>
7406 </listitem>
7407 </varlistentry>
7411 <varlistentry>
7412 <term><anchor id="STRICTALLOCATE">strict allocate (S)</term>
7413 <listitem><para>This is a boolean that controls the handling of
7414 disk space allocation in the server. When this is set to <constant>yes</constant>
7415 the server will change from UNIX behaviour of not committing real
7416 disk storage blocks when a file is extended to the Windows behaviour
7417 of actually forcing the disk system to allocate real storage blocks
7418 when a file is created or extended to be a given size. In UNIX
7419 terminology this means that Samba will stop creating sparse files.
7420 This can be slow on some systems.</para>
7422 <para>When strict allocate is <constant>no</constant> the server does sparse
7423 disk block allocation when a file is extended.</para>
7425 <para>Setting this to <constant>yes</constant> can help Samba return
7426 out of quota messages on systems that are restricting the disk quota
7427 of users.</para>
7429 <para>Default: <command>strict allocate = no</command></para>
7430 </listitem>
7431 </varlistentry>
7435 <varlistentry>
7436 <term><anchor id="STRICTLOCKING">strict locking (S)</term>
7437 <listitem><para>This is a boolean that controls the handling of
7438 file locking in the server. When this is set to <constant>yes</constant>
7439 the server will check every read and write access for file locks, and
7440 deny access if locks exist. This can be slow on some systems.</para>
7442 <para>When strict locking is <constant>no</constant> the server does file
7443 lock checks only when the client explicitly asks for them.</para>
7445 <para>Well-behaved clients always ask for lock checks when it
7446 is important, so in the vast majority of cases <command>strict
7447 locking = no</command> is preferable.</para>
7449 <para>Default: <command>strict locking = no</command></para>
7450 </listitem>
7451 </varlistentry>
7455 <varlistentry>
7456 <term><anchor id="STRICTSYNC">strict sync (S)</term>
7457 <listitem><para>Many Windows applications (including the Windows
7458 98 explorer shell) seem to confuse flushing buffer contents to
7459 disk with doing a sync to disk. Under UNIX, a sync call forces
7460 the process to be suspended until the kernel has ensured that
7461 all outstanding data in kernel disk buffers has been safely stored
7462 onto stable storage. This is very slow and should only be done
7463 rarely. Setting this parameter to <constant>no</constant> (the
7464 default) means that <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> ignores the Windows applications requests for
7465 a sync call. There is only a possibility of losing data if the
7466 operating system itself that Samba is running on crashes, so there is
7467 little danger in this default setting. In addition, this fixes many
7468 performance problems that people have reported with the new Windows98
7469 explorer shell file copies.</para>
7471 <para>See also the <link linkend="SYNCALWAYS"><parameter>sync
7472 always></parameter></link> parameter.</para>
7474 <para>Default: <command>strict sync = no</command></para>
7475 </listitem>
7476 </varlistentry>
7479 <varlistentry>
7480 <term><anchor id="STRIPDOT">strip dot (G)</term>
7481 <listitem><para>This is a boolean that controls whether to
7482 strip trailing dots off UNIX filenames. This helps with some
7483 CDROMs that have filenames ending in a single dot.</para>
7485 <para>Default: <command>strip dot = no</command></para>
7486 </listitem>
7487 </varlistentry>
7491 <varlistentry>
7492 <term><anchor id="SYNCALWAYS">sync always (S)</term>
7493 <listitem><para>This is a boolean parameter that controls
7494 whether writes will always be written to stable storage before
7495 the write call returns. If this is <constant>false</constant> then the server will be
7496 guided by the client's request in each write call (clients can
7497 set a bit indicating that a particular write should be synchronous).
7498 If this is <constant>true</constant> then every write will be followed by a <command>fsync()
7499 </command> call to ensure the data is written to disk. Note that
7500 the <parameter>strict sync</parameter> parameter must be set to
7501 <constant>yes</constant> in order for this parameter to have
7502 any affect.</para>
7504 <para>See also the <link linkend="STRICTSYNC"><parameter>strict
7505 sync</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
7507 <para>Default: <command>sync always = no</command></para>
7508 </listitem>
7509 </varlistentry>
7513 <varlistentry>
7514 <term><anchor id="SYSLOG">syslog (G)</term>
7515 <listitem><para>This parameter maps how Samba debug messages
7516 are logged onto the system syslog logging levels. Samba debug
7517 level zero maps onto syslog <constant>LOG_ERR</constant>, debug
7518 level one maps onto <constant>LOG_WARNING</constant>, debug level
7519 two maps onto <constant>LOG_NOTICE</constant>, debug level three
7520 maps onto LOG_INFO. All higher levels are mapped to <constant>
7521 LOG_DEBUG</constant>.</para>
7523 <para>This parameter sets the threshold for sending messages
7524 to syslog. Only messages with debug level less than this value
7525 will be sent to syslog.</para>
7527 <para>Default: <command>syslog = 1</command></para>
7528 </listitem>
7529 </varlistentry>
7533 <varlistentry>
7534 <term><anchor id="SYSLOGONLY">syslog only (G)</term>
7535 <listitem><para>If this parameter is set then Samba debug
7536 messages are logged into the system syslog only, and not to
7537 the debug log files.</para>
7539 <para>Default: <command>syslog only = no</command></para>
7540 </listitem>
7541 </varlistentry>
7545 <varlistentry>
7546 <term><anchor id="TEMPLATEHOMEDIR">template homedir (G)</term>
7547 <listitem><para>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT
7548 user, the <ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink> daemon
7549 uses this parameter to fill in the home directory for that user.
7550 If the string <parameter>%D</parameter> is present it is substituted
7551 with the user's Windows NT domain name. If the string <parameter>%U
7552 </parameter> is present it is substituted with the user's Windows
7553 NT user name.</para>
7555 <para>Default: <command>template homedir = /home/%D/%U</command></para>
7556 </listitem>
7557 </varlistentry>
7561 <varlistentry>
7562 <term><anchor id="TEMPLATESHELL">template shell (G)</term>
7563 <listitem><para>When filling out the user information for a Windows NT
7564 user, the <ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink> daemon
7565 uses this parameter to fill in the login shell for that user.</para>
7567 <para>Default: <command>template shell = /bin/false</command></para>
7568 </listitem>
7569 </varlistentry>
7573 <varlistentry>
7574 <term><anchor id="TIMEOFFSET">time offset (G)</term>
7575 <listitem><para>This parameter is a setting in minutes to add
7576 to the normal GMT to local time conversion. This is useful if
7577 you are serving a lot of PCs that have incorrect daylight
7578 saving time handling.</para>
7580 <para>Default: <command>time offset = 0</command></para>
7581 <para>Example: <command>time offset = 60</command></para>
7582 </listitem>
7583 </varlistentry>
7587 <varlistentry>
7588 <term><anchor id="TIMESERVER">time server (G)</term>
7589 <listitem><para>This parameter determines if <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">
7590 nmbd(8)</ulink> advertises itself as a time server to Windows
7591 clients.</para>
7593 <para>Default: <command>time server = no</command></para>
7594 </listitem>
7595 </varlistentry>
7598 <varlistentry>
7599 <term><anchor id="TIMESTAMPLOGS">timestamp logs (G)</term>
7600 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="DEBUGTIMESTAMP"><parameter>
7601 debug timestamp</parameter></link>.</para>
7602 </listitem>
7603 </varlistentry>
7609 <varlistentry>
7610 <term><anchor id="TOTALPRINTJOBS">total print jobs (G)</term>
7611 <listitem><para>This parameter accepts an integer value which defines
7612 a limit on the maximum number of print jobs that will be accepted
7613 system wide at any given time. If a print job is submitted
7614 by a client which will exceed this number, then <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd</ulink> will return an
7615 error indicating that no space is available on the server. The
7616 default value of 0 means that no such limit exists. This parameter
7617 can be used to prevent a server from exceeding its capacity and is
7618 designed as a printing throttle. See also
7619 <link linkend="MAXPRINTJOBS"><parameter>max print jobs</parameter</link>.
7620 </para>
7622 <para>Default: <command>total print jobs = 0</command></para>
7623 <para>Example: <command>total print jobs = 5000</command></para>
7624 </listitem>
7625 </varlistentry>
7630 <varlistentry>
7631 <term><anchor id="UNIXEXTENSIONS">unix extensions(G)</term>
7632 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba
7633 implments the CIFS UNIX extensions, as defined by HP. These
7634 extensions enable CIFS to server UNIX clients to UNIX servers
7635 better, and allow such things as symbolic links, hard links etc.
7636 These extensions require a similarly enabled client, and are of
7637 no current use to Windows clients.</para>
7639 <para>Default: <command>unix extensions = no</command></para>
7640 </listitem>
7641 </varlistentry>
7646 <varlistentry>
7647 <term><anchor id="UNIXPASSWORDSYNC">unix password sync (G)</term>
7648 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter controls whether Samba
7649 attempts to synchronize the UNIX password with the SMB password
7650 when the encrypted SMB password in the smbpasswd file is changed.
7651 If this is set to <constant>true</constant> the program specified in the <parameter>passwd
7652 program</parameter>parameter is called <emphasis>AS ROOT</emphasis> -
7653 to allow the new UNIX password to be set without access to the
7654 old UNIX password (as the SMB password change code has no
7655 access to the old password cleartext, only the new).</para>
7657 <para>See also <link linkend="PASSWDPROGRAM"><parameter>passwd
7658 program</parameter></link>, <link linkend="PASSWDCHAT"><parameter>
7659 passwd chat</parameter></link>.</para>
7661 <para>Default: <command>unix password sync = no</command></para>
7662 </listitem>
7663 </varlistentry>
7667 <varlistentry>
7668 <term><anchor id="UPDATEENCRYPTED">update encrypted (G)</term>
7669 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter allows a user logging
7670 on with a plaintext password to have their encrypted (hashed)
7671 password in the smbpasswd file to be updated automatically as
7672 they log on. This option allows a site to migrate from plaintext
7673 password authentication (users authenticate with plaintext
7674 password over the wire, and are checked against a UNIX account
7675 database) to encrypted password authentication (the SMB
7676 challenge/response authentication mechanism) without forcing
7677 all users to re-enter their passwords via smbpasswd at the time the
7678 change is made. This is a convenience option to allow the change over
7679 to encrypted passwords to be made over a longer period. Once all users
7680 have encrypted representations of their passwords in the smbpasswd
7681 file this parameter should be set to <constant>no</constant>.</para>
7683 <para>In order for this parameter to work correctly the <link
7684 linkend="ENCRYPTPASSWORDS"><parameter>encrypt passwords</parameter>
7685 </link> parameter must be set to <constant>no</constant> when
7686 this parameter is set to <constant>yes</constant>.</para>
7688 <para>Note that even when this parameter is set a user
7689 authenticating to <command>smbd</command> must still enter a valid
7690 password in order to connect correctly, and to update their hashed
7691 (smbpasswd) passwords.</para>
7693 <para>Default: <command>update encrypted = no</command></para>
7694 </listitem>
7695 </varlistentry>
7698 <varlistentry>
7699 <term><anchor id="USECLIENTDRIVER">use client driver (S)</term>
7700 <listitem><para>This parameter applies only to Windows NT/2000
7701 clients. It has no affect on Windows 95/98/ME clients. When
7702 serving a printer to Windows NT/2000 clients without first installing
7703 a valid printer driver on the Samba host, the client will be required
7704 to install a local printer driver. From this point on, the client
7705 will treat the print as a local printer and not a network printer
7706 connection. This is much the same behavior that will occur
7707 when <command>disable spoolss = yes</command>. </para>
7709 <para>The differentiating
7710 factor is that under normal circumstances, the NT/2000 client will
7711 attempt to open the network printer using MS-RPC. The problem is that
7712 because the client considers the printer to be local, it will attempt
7713 to issue the OpenPrinterEx() call requesting access rights associated
7714 with the logged on user. If the user possesses local administator rights
7715 but not root privilegde on the Samba host (often the case), the OpenPrinterEx()
7716 call will fail. The result is that the client will now display an "Access
7717 Denied; Unable to connect" message in the printer queue window (even though
7718 jobs may successfully be printed). </para>
7720 <para>If this parameter is enabled for a printer, then any attempt
7721 to open the printer with the PRINTER_ACCESS_ADMINISTER right is mapped
7722 to PRINTER_ACCESS_USE instead. Thus allowing the OpenPrinterEx()
7723 call to succeed. <emphasis>This parameter MUST not be able enabled
7724 on a print share which has valid print driver installed on the Samba
7725 server.</emphasis></para>
7727 <para>See also <link linkend="DISABLESPOOLSS">disable spoolss</link>
7728 </para>
7730 <para>Default: <command>use client driver = no</command></para>
7731 </listitem>
7732 </varlistentry>
7736 <varlistentry>
7737 <term><anchor id="USEMMAP">use mmap (G)</term>
7738 <listitem><para>This global parameter determines if the tdb internals of Samba can
7739 depend on mmap working correctly on the running system. Samba requires a coherent
7740 mmap/read-write system memory cache. Currently only HPUX does not have such a
7741 coherent cache, and so this parameter is set to <constant>false</constant> by
7742 default on HPUX. On all other systems this parameter should be left alone. This
7743 parameter is provided to help the Samba developers track down problems with
7744 the tdb internal code.
7745 </para>
7747 <para>Default: <command>use mmap = yes</command></para>
7748 </listitem>
7749 </varlistentry>
7754 <varlistentry>
7755 <term><anchor id="USERHOSTS">use rhosts (G)</term>
7756 <listitem><para>If this global parameter is <constant>true</constant>, it specifies
7757 that the UNIX user's <filename>.rhosts</filename> file in their home directory
7758 will be read to find the names of hosts and users who will be allowed
7759 access without specifying a password.</para>
7761 <para><emphasis>NOTE:</emphasis> The use of <parameter>use rhosts
7762 </parameter> can be a major security hole. This is because you are
7763 trusting the PC to supply the correct username. It is very easy to
7764 get a PC to supply a false username. I recommend that the <parameter>
7765 use rhosts</parameter> option be only used if you really know what
7766 you are doing.</para>
7768 <para>Default: <command>use rhosts = no</command></para>
7769 </listitem>
7770 </varlistentry>
7774 <varlistentry>
7775 <term><anchor id="USER">user (S)</term>
7776 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="USERNAME"><parameter>
7777 username</parameter></link>.</para>
7778 </listitem>
7779 </varlistentry>
7783 <varlistentry>
7784 <term><anchor id="USERS">users (S)</term>
7785 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="USERNAME"><parameter>
7786 username</parameter></link>.</para>
7787 </listitem>
7788 </varlistentry>
7791 <varlistentry>
7792 <term><anchor id="USERNAME">username (S)</term>
7793 <listitem><para>Multiple users may be specified in a comma-delimited
7794 list, in which case the supplied password will be tested against
7795 each username in turn (left to right).</para>
7797 <para>The <parameter>username</parameter> line is needed only when
7798 the PC is unable to supply its own username. This is the case
7799 for the COREPLUS protocol or where your users have different WfWg
7800 usernames to UNIX usernames. In both these cases you may also be
7801 better using the \\server\share%user syntax instead.</para>
7803 <para>The <parameter>username</parameter> line is not a great
7804 solution in many cases as it means Samba will try to validate
7805 the supplied password against each of the usernames in the
7806 <parameter>username</parameter> line in turn. This is slow and
7807 a bad idea for lots of users in case of duplicate passwords.
7808 You may get timeouts or security breaches using this parameter
7809 unwisely.</para>
7811 <para>Samba relies on the underlying UNIX security. This
7812 parameter does not restrict who can login, it just offers hints
7813 to the Samba server as to what usernames might correspond to the
7814 supplied password. Users can login as whoever they please and
7815 they will be able to do no more damage than if they started a
7816 telnet session. The daemon runs as the user that they log in as,
7817 so they cannot do anything that user cannot do.</para>
7819 <para>To restrict a service to a particular set of users you
7820 can use the <link linkend="VALIDUSERS"><parameter>valid users
7821 </parameter></link> parameter.</para>
7823 <para>If any of the usernames begin with a '@' then the name
7824 will be looked up first in the NIS netgroups list (if Samba
7825 is compiled with netgroup support), followed by a lookup in
7826 the UNIX groups database and will expand to a list of all users
7827 in the group of that name.</para>
7829 <para>If any of the usernames begin with a '+' then the name
7830 will be looked up only in the UNIX groups database and will
7831 expand to a list of all users in the group of that name.</para>
7833 <para>If any of the usernames begin with a '&'then the name
7834 will be looked up only in the NIS netgroups database (if Samba
7835 is compiled with netgroup support) and will expand to a list
7836 of all users in the netgroup group of that name.</para>
7838 <para>Note that searching though a groups database can take
7839 quite some time, and some clients may time out during the
7840 search.</para>
7842 <para>See the section <link linkend="VALIDATIONSECT">NOTE ABOUT
7843 USERNAME/PASSWORD VALIDATION</link> for more information on how
7844 this parameter determines access to the services.</para>
7846 <para>Default: <command>The guest account if a guest service,
7847 else &lt;empty string&gt;.</command></para>
7849 <para>Examples:<command>username = fred, mary, jack, jane,
7850 @users, @pcgroup</command></para>
7851 </listitem>
7852 </varlistentry>
7856 <varlistentry>
7857 <term><anchor id="USERNAMELEVEL">username level (G)</term>
7858 <listitem><para>This option helps Samba to try and 'guess' at
7859 the real UNIX username, as many DOS clients send an all-uppercase
7860 username. By default Samba tries all lowercase, followed by the
7861 username with the first letter capitalized, and fails if the
7862 username is not found on the UNIX machine.</para>
7864 <para>If this parameter is set to non-zero the behavior changes.
7865 This parameter is a number that specifies the number of uppercase
7866 combinations to try while trying to determine the UNIX user name. The
7867 higher the number the more combinations will be tried, but the slower
7868 the discovery of usernames will be. Use this parameter when you have
7869 strange usernames on your UNIX machine, such as <constant>AstrangeUser
7870 </constant>.</para>
7872 <para>Default: <command>username level = 0</command></para>
7873 <para>Example: <command>username level = 5</command></para>
7874 </listitem>
7875 </varlistentry>
7879 <varlistentry>
7880 <term><anchor id="USERNAMEMAP">username map (G)</term>
7881 <listitem><para>This option allows you to specify a file containing
7882 a mapping of usernames from the clients to the server. This can be
7883 used for several purposes. The most common is to map usernames
7884 that users use on DOS or Windows machines to those that the UNIX
7885 box uses. The other is to map multiple users to a single username
7886 so that they can more easily share files.</para>
7888 <para>The map file is parsed line by line. Each line should
7889 contain a single UNIX username on the left then a '=' followed
7890 by a list of usernames on the right. The list of usernames on the
7891 right may contain names of the form @group in which case they
7892 will match any UNIX username in that group. The special client
7893 name '*' is a wildcard and matches any name. Each line of the
7894 map file may be up to 1023 characters long.</para>
7896 <para>The file is processed on each line by taking the
7897 supplied username and comparing it with each username on the right
7898 hand side of the '=' signs. If the supplied name matches any of
7899 the names on the right hand side then it is replaced with the name
7900 on the left. Processing then continues with the next line.</para>
7902 <para>If any line begins with a '#' or a ';' then it is
7903 ignored</para>
7905 <para>If any line begins with an '!' then the processing
7906 will stop after that line if a mapping was done by the line.
7907 Otherwise mapping continues with every line being processed.
7908 Using '!' is most useful when you have a wildcard mapping line
7909 later in the file.</para>
7911 <para>For example to map from the name <constant>admin</constant>
7912 or <constant>administrator</constant> to the UNIX name <constant>
7913 root</constant> you would use:</para>
7915 <para><command>root = admin administrator</command></para>
7917 <para>Or to map anyone in the UNIX group <constant>system</constant>
7918 to the UNIX name <constant>sys</constant> you would use:</para>
7920 <para><command>sys = @system</command></para>
7922 <para>You can have as many mappings as you like in a username
7923 map file.</para>
7926 <para>If your system supports the NIS NETGROUP option then
7927 the netgroup database is checked before the <filename>/etc/group
7928 </filename> database for matching groups.</para>
7930 <para>You can map Windows usernames that have spaces in them
7931 by using double quotes around the name. For example:</para>
7933 <para><command>tridge = "Andrew Tridgell"</command></para>
7935 <para>would map the windows username "Andrew Tridgell" to the
7936 unix username "tridge".</para>
7938 <para>The following example would map mary and fred to the
7939 unix user sys, and map the rest to guest. Note the use of the
7940 '!' to tell Samba to stop processing if it gets a match on
7941 that line.</para>
7943 <para><programlisting>
7944 !sys = mary fred
7945 guest = *
7946 </programlisting></para>
7948 <para>Note that the remapping is applied to all occurrences
7949 of usernames. Thus if you connect to \\server\fred and <constant>
7950 fred</constant> is remapped to <constant>mary</constant> then you
7951 will actually be connecting to \\server\mary and will need to
7952 supply a password suitable for <constant>mary</constant> not
7953 <constant>fred</constant>. The only exception to this is the
7954 username passed to the <link linkend="PASSWORDSERVER"><parameter>
7955 password server</parameter></link> (if you have one). The password
7956 server will receive whatever username the client supplies without
7957 modification.</para>
7959 <para>Also note that no reverse mapping is done. The main effect
7960 this has is with printing. Users who have been mapped may have
7961 trouble deleting print jobs as PrintManager under WfWg will think
7962 they don't own the print job.</para>
7964 <para>Default: <emphasis>no username map</emphasis></para>
7965 <para>Example: <command>username map = /usr/local/samba/lib/users.map
7966 </command></para>
7967 </listitem>
7968 </varlistentry>
7972 <varlistentry>
7973 <term><anchor id="UTMP">utmp (G)</term>
7974 <listitem><para>This boolean parameter is only available if
7975 Samba has been configured and compiled with the option <command>
7976 --with-utmp</command>. If set to <constant>true</constant> then Samba will attempt
7977 to add utmp or utmpx records (depending on the UNIX system) whenever a
7978 connection is made to a Samba server. Sites may use this to record the
7979 user connecting to a Samba share.</para>
7981 <para>See also the <link linkend="UTMPDIRECTORY"><parameter>
7982 utmp directory</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
7984 <para>Default: <command>utmp = no</command></para>
7985 </listitem>
7986 </varlistentry>
7990 <varlistentry>
7991 <term><anchor id="UTMPDIRECTORY">utmp directory(G)</term>
7992 <listitem><para>This parameter is only available if Samba has
7993 been configured and compiled with the option <command>
7994 --with-utmp</command>. It specifies a directory pathname that is
7995 used to store the utmp or utmpx files (depending on the UNIX system) that
7996 record user connections to a Samba server. See also the <link linkend="UTMP">
7997 <parameter>utmp</parameter></link> parameter. By default this is
7998 not set, meaning the system will use whatever utmp file the
7999 native system is set to use (usually
8000 <filename>/var/run/utmp</filename> on Linux).</para>
8002 <para>Default: <emphasis>no utmp directory</emphasis></para>
8003 </listitem>
8004 </varlistentry>
8008 <varlistentry>
8009 <term><anchor id="VALIDCHARS">valid chars (G)</term>
8010 <listitem><para>The option allows you to specify additional
8011 characters that should be considered valid by the server in
8012 filenames. This is particularly useful for national character
8013 sets, such as adding u-umlaut or a-ring.</para>
8015 <para>The option takes a list of characters in either integer
8016 or character form with spaces between them. If you give two
8017 characters with a colon between them then it will be taken as
8018 an lowercase:uppercase pair.</para>
8020 <para>If you have an editor capable of entering the characters
8021 into the config file then it is probably easiest to use this
8022 method. Otherwise you can specify the characters in octal,
8023 decimal or hexadecimal form using the usual C notation.</para>
8025 <para>For example to add the single character 'Z' to the charset
8026 (which is a pointless thing to do as it's already there) you could
8027 do one of the following</para>
8029 <para><programlisting>
8030 valid chars = Z
8031 valid chars = z:Z
8032 valid chars = 0132:0172
8033 </programlisting></para>
8035 <para>The last two examples above actually add two characters,
8036 and alter the uppercase and lowercase mappings appropriately.</para>
8038 <para>Note that you <emphasis>MUST</emphasis> specify this parameter
8039 after the <parameter>client code page</parameter> parameter if you
8040 have both set. If <parameter>client code page</parameter> is set after
8041 the <parameter>valid chars</parameter> parameter the <parameter>valid
8042 chars</parameter> settings will be overwritten.</para>
8044 <para>See also the <link linkend="CLIENTCODEPAGE"><parameter>client
8045 code page</parameter></link> parameter.</para>
8047 <para>Default: <emphasis>Samba defaults to using a reasonable set
8048 of valid characters for English systems</emphasis></para>
8050 <para>Example: <command>valid chars = 0345:0305 0366:0326 0344:0304
8051 </command></para>
8053 <para>The above example allows filenames to have the Swedish
8054 characters in them.</para>
8056 <para><emphasis>NOTE:</emphasis> It is actually quite difficult to
8057 correctly produce a <parameter>valid chars</parameter> line for
8058 a particular system. To automate the process <ulink
8059 url="mailto:tino@augsburg.net">tino@augsburg.net</ulink> has written
8060 a package called <command>validchars</command> which will automatically
8061 produce a complete <parameter>valid chars</parameter> line for
8062 a given client system. Look in the <filename>examples/validchars/
8063 </filename> subdirectory of your Samba source code distribution
8064 for this package.</para>
8065 </listitem>
8066 </varlistentry>
8070 <varlistentry>
8071 <term><anchor id="VALIDUSERS">valid users (S)</term>
8072 <listitem><para>This is a list of users that should be allowed
8073 to login to this service. Names starting with '@', '+' and '&'
8074 are interpreted using the same rules as described in the
8075 <parameter>invalid users</parameter> parameter.</para>
8077 <para>If this is empty (the default) then any user can login.
8078 If a username is in both this list and the <parameter>invalid
8079 users</parameter> list then access is denied for that user.</para>
8081 <para>The current servicename is substituted for <parameter>%S
8082 </parameter>. This is useful in the [homes] section.</para>
8084 <para>See also <link linkend="INVALIDUSERS"><parameter>invalid users
8085 </parameter></link></para>
8087 <para>Default: <emphasis>No valid users list (anyone can login)
8088 </emphasis></para>
8090 <para>Example: <command>valid users = greg, @pcusers</command></para>
8091 </listitem>
8092 </varlistentry>
8097 <varlistentry>
8098 <term><anchor id="VETOFILES">veto files(S)</term>
8099 <listitem><para>This is a list of files and directories that
8100 are neither visible nor accessible. Each entry in the list must
8101 be separated by a '/', which allows spaces to be included
8102 in the entry. '*' and '?' can be used to specify multiple files
8103 or directories as in DOS wildcards.</para>
8105 <para>Each entry must be a unix path, not a DOS path and
8106 must <emphasis>not</emphasis> include the unix directory
8107 separator '/'.</para>
8109 <para>Note that the <parameter>case sensitive</parameter> option
8110 is applicable in vetoing files.</para>
8112 <para>One feature of the veto files parameter that it
8113 is important to be aware of is Samba's behaviour when
8114 trying to delete a directory. If a directory that is
8115 to be deleted contains nothing but veto files this
8116 deletion will <emphasis>fail</emphasis> unless you also set
8117 the <parameter>delete veto files</parameter> parameter to
8118 <parameter>yes</parameter>.</para>
8120 <para>Setting this parameter will affect the performance
8121 of Samba, as it will be forced to check all files and directories
8122 for a match as they are scanned.</para>
8124 <para>See also <link linkend="HIDEFILES"><parameter>hide files
8125 </parameter></link> and <link linkend="CASESENSITIVE"><parameter>
8126 case sensitive</parameter></link>.</para>
8128 <para>Default: <emphasis>No files or directories are vetoed.
8129 </emphasis></para>
8131 <para>Examples:<programlisting>
8132 ; Veto any files containing the word Security,
8133 ; any ending in .tmp, and any directory containing the
8134 ; word root.
8135 veto files = /*Security*/*.tmp/*root*/
8137 ; Veto the Apple specific files that a NetAtalk server
8138 ; creates.
8139 veto files = /.AppleDouble/.bin/.AppleDesktop/Network Trash Folder/
8140 </programlisting></para>
8141 </listitem>
8142 </varlistentry>
8145 <varlistentry>
8146 <term><anchor id="VETOOPLOCKFILES">veto oplock files (S)</term>
8147 <listitem><para>This parameter is only valid when the <link
8148 linkend="OPLOCKS"><parameter>oplocks</parameter></link>
8149 parameter is turned on for a share. It allows the Samba administrator
8150 to selectively turn off the granting of oplocks on selected files that
8151 match a wildcarded list, similar to the wildcarded list used in the
8152 <link linkend="VETOFILES"><parameter>veto files</parameter></link>
8153 parameter.</para>
8155 <para>Default: <emphasis>No files are vetoed for oplock
8156 grants</emphasis></para>
8158 <para>You might want to do this on files that you know will
8159 be heavily contended for by clients. A good example of this
8160 is in the NetBench SMB benchmark program, which causes heavy
8161 client contention for files ending in <filename>.SEM</filename>.
8162 To cause Samba not to grant oplocks on these files you would use
8163 the line (either in the [global] section or in the section for
8164 the particular NetBench share :</para>
8166 <para>Example: <command>veto oplock files = /*.SEM/
8167 </command></para>
8168 </listitem>
8169 </varlistentry>
8173 <varlistentry>
8174 <term><anchor id="VFSOBJECT">vfs object (S)</term>
8175 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies a shared object file that
8176 is used for Samba VFS I/O operations. By default, normal
8177 disk I/O operations are used but these can be overloaded
8178 with a VFS object. The Samba VFS layer is new to Samba 2.2 and
8179 must be enabled at compile time with --with-vfs.</para>
8181 <para>Default : <emphasis>no value</emphasis></para>
8182 </listitem>
8183 </varlistentry>
8188 <varlistentry>
8189 <term><anchor id="VFSOPTIONS">vfs options (S)</term>
8190 <listitem><para>This parameter allows parameters to be passed
8191 to the vfs layer at initialization time. The Samba VFS layer
8192 is new to Samba 2.2 and must be enabled at compile time
8193 with --with-vfs. See also <link linkend="VFSOBJECT"><parameter>
8194 vfs object</parameter></link>.</para>
8196 <para>Default : <emphasis>no value</emphasis></para>
8197 </listitem>
8198 </varlistentry>
8202 <varlistentry>
8203 <term><anchor id="VOLUME">volume (S)</term>
8204 <listitem><para> This allows you to override the volume label
8205 returned for a share. Useful for CDROMs with installation programs
8206 that insist on a particular volume label.</para>
8208 <para>Default: <emphasis>the name of the share</emphasis></para>
8209 </listitem>
8210 </varlistentry>
8214 <varlistentry>
8215 <term><anchor id="WIDELINKS">wide links (S)</term>
8216 <listitem><para>This parameter controls whether or not links
8217 in the UNIX file system may be followed by the server. Links
8218 that point to areas within the directory tree exported by the
8219 server are always allowed; this parameter controls access only
8220 to areas that are outside the directory tree being exported.</para>
8222 <para>Note that setting this parameter can have a negative
8223 effect on your server performance due to the extra system calls
8224 that Samba has to do in order to perform the link checks.</para>
8226 <para>Default: <command>wide links = yes</command></para>
8227 </listitem>
8228 </varlistentry>
8233 <varlistentry>
8234 <term><anchor id="WINBINDCACHETIME">winbind cache time (G)</term>
8235 <listitem><para>This parameter specifies the number of seconds the
8236 <ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink> daemon will cache
8237 user and group information before querying a Windows NT server
8238 again.</para>
8240 <para>Default: <command>winbind cache type = 15</command></para>
8241 </listitem>
8242 </varlistentry>
8245 <varlistentry>
8246 <term><anchor id="WINBINDENUMUSERS">winbind enum users (G)</term>
8247 <listitem><para>On large installations using
8248 <ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink> it may be
8249 necessary to suppress the enumeration of users through the
8250 <command> setpwent()</command>,
8251 <command>getpwent()</command> and
8252 <command>endpwent()</command> group of system calls. If
8253 the <parameter>winbind enum users</parameter> parameter is
8254 false, calls to the <command>getpwent</command> system call
8255 will not return any data. </para>
8257 <para><emphasis>Warning:</emphasis> Turning off user
8258 enumeration may cause some programs to behave oddly. For
8259 example, the finger program relies on having access to the
8260 full user list when searching for matching
8261 usernames. </para>
8263 <para>Default: <command>winbind enum users = yes </command></para>
8264 </listitem>
8265 </varlistentry>
8267 <varlistentry>
8268 <term><anchor id="WINBINDENUMGROUPS">winbind enum groups (G)</term>
8269 <listitem><para>On large installations using
8270 <ulink url="winbindd.8.html">winbindd(8)</ulink> it may be
8271 necessary to suppress the enumeration of groups through the
8272 <command> setgrent()</command>,
8273 <command>getgrent()</command> and
8274 <command>endgrent()</command> group of system calls. If
8275 the <parameter>winbind enum groups</parameter> parameter is
8276 false, calls to the <command>getgrent()</command> system
8277 call will not return any data. </para>
8279 <para><emphasis>Warning:</emphasis> Turning off group
8280 enumeration may cause some programs to behave oddly.
8281 </para>
8283 <para>Default: <command>winbind enum groups = yes </command>
8284 </para></listitem>
8285 </varlistentry>
8288 <varlistentry>
8289 <term><anchor id="WINBINDGID">winbind gid (G)</term>
8290 <listitem><para>The winbind gid parameter specifies the range of group
8291 ids that are allocated by the <ulink url="winbindd.8.html">
8292 winbindd(8)</ulink> daemon. This range of group ids should have no
8293 existing local or NIS groups within it as strange conflicts can
8294 occur otherwise.</para>
8296 <para>Default: <command>winbind gid = &lt;empty string&gt;
8297 </command></para>
8299 <para>Example: <command>winbind gid = 10000-20000</command></para>
8300 </listitem>
8301 </varlistentry>
8304 <varlistentry>
8305 <term><anchor id="WINBINDSEPARATOR">winbind separator (G)</term>
8306 <listitem><para>This parameter allows an admin to define the character
8307 used when listing a username of the form of <replaceable>DOMAIN
8308 </replaceable>\<replaceable>user</replaceable>. This parameter
8309 is only applicable when using the <filename>pam_winbind.so</filename>
8310 and <filename>nss_winbind.so</filename> modules for UNIX services.
8311 </para>
8313 <para>Please note that setting this parameter to + causes problems
8314 with group membership at least on glibc systems, as the character +
8315 is used as a special character for NIS in /etc/group.</para>
8317 <para>Default: <command>winbind separator = '\'</command></para>
8318 <para>Example: <command>winbind separator = +</command></para>
8319 </listitem>
8320 </varlistentry>
8325 <varlistentry>
8326 <term><anchor id="WINBINDUID">winbind uid (G)</term>
8327 <listitem><para>The winbind gid parameter specifies the range of group
8328 ids that are allocated by the <ulink url="winbindd.8.html">
8329 winbindd(8)</ulink> daemon. This range of ids should have no
8330 existing local or NIS users within it as strange conflicts can
8331 occur otherwise.</para>
8333 <para>Default: <command>winbind uid = &lt;empty string&gt;
8334 </command></para>
8336 <para>Example: <command>winbind uid = 10000-20000</command></para>
8337 </listitem>
8338 </varlistentry>
8343 <varlistentry>
8344 <term><anchor id="WINBINDUSEDEFAULTDOMAIN">winbind use default domain (G)</term>
8345 <listitem><para>This option controls whether or not smbd
8346 should lookup 'username' as 'DOMAIN\username' when winbindd is
8347 running on a system. This is most useful when used in conjunction
8348 with pam_winbind.so to prevent a Windows user from having to enter
8349 commands like "ssh 'DOMAIN\username@hostname'". This option is disabled
8350 by default, thus requiring that the DOMAIN\username format be used.</para>
8352 <para>Default: <command>winbind use default domain = no</command>
8353 </para></listitem>
8354 </varlistentry>
8360 <varlistentry>
8361 <term><anchor id="WINSHOOK">wins hook (G)</term>
8362 <listitem><para>When Samba is running as a WINS server this
8363 allows you to call an external program for all changes to the
8364 WINS database. The primary use for this option is to allow the
8365 dynamic update of external name resolution databases such as
8366 dynamic DNS.</para>
8368 <para>The wins hook parameter specifies the name of a script
8369 or executable that will be called as follows:</para>
8371 <para><command>wins_hook operation name nametype ttl IP_list
8372 </command></para>
8374 <itemizedlist>
8375 <listitem><para>The first argument is the operation and is one
8376 of "add", "delete", or "refresh". In most cases the operation can
8377 be ignored as the rest of the parameters provide sufficient
8378 information. Note that "refresh" may sometimes be called when the
8379 name has not previously been added, in that case it should be treated
8380 as an add.</para></listitem>
8382 <listitem><para>The second argument is the NetBIOS name. If the
8383 name is not a legal name then the wins hook is not called.
8384 Legal names contain only letters, digits, hyphens, underscores
8385 and periods.</para></listitem>
8387 <listitem><para>The third argument is the NetBIOS name
8388 type as a 2 digit hexadecimal number. </para></listitem>
8390 <listitem><para>The fourth argument is the TTL (time to live)
8391 for the name in seconds.</para></listitem>
8393 <listitem><para>The fifth and subsequent arguments are the IP
8394 addresses currently registered for that name. If this list is
8395 empty then the name should be deleted.</para></listitem>
8396 </itemizedlist>
8398 <para>An example script that calls the BIND dynamic DNS update
8399 program <command>nsupdate</command> is provided in the examples
8400 directory of the Samba source code. </para>
8401 </listitem>
8402 </varlistentry>
8408 <varlistentry>
8409 <term><anchor id="WINSPROXY">wins proxy (G)</term>
8410 <listitem><para>This is a boolean that controls if <ulink
8411 url="nmbd.8.html">nmbd(8)</ulink> will respond to broadcast name
8412 queries on behalf of other hosts. You may need to set this
8413 to <constant>yes</constant> for some older clients.</para>
8415 <para>Default: <command>wins proxy = no</command></para>
8416 </listitem>
8417 </varlistentry>
8422 <varlistentry>
8423 <term><anchor id="WINSSERVER">wins server (G)</term>
8424 <listitem><para>This specifies the IP address (or DNS name: IP
8425 address for preference) of the WINS server that <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">
8426 nmbd(8)</ulink> should register with. If you have a WINS server on
8427 your network then you should set this to the WINS server's IP.</para>
8429 <para>You should point this at your WINS server if you have a
8430 multi-subnetted network.</para>
8432 <para><emphasis>NOTE</emphasis>. You need to set up Samba to point
8433 to a WINS server if you have multiple subnets and wish cross-subnet
8434 browsing to work correctly.</para>
8436 <para>See the documentation file <filename>BROWSING.txt</filename>
8437 in the docs/ directory of your Samba source distribution.</para>
8439 <para>Default: <emphasis>not enabled</emphasis></para>
8440 <para>Example: <command>wins server = 192.9.200.1</command></para>
8441 </listitem>
8442 </varlistentry>
8446 <varlistentry>
8447 <term><anchor id="WINSSUPPORT">wins support (G)</term>
8448 <listitem><para>This boolean controls if the <ulink url="nmbd.8.html">
8449 nmbd(8)</ulink> process in Samba will act as a WINS server. You should
8450 not set this to <constant>true</constant> unless you have a multi-subnetted network and
8451 you wish a particular <command>nmbd</command> to be your WINS server.
8452 Note that you should <emphasis>NEVER</emphasis> set this to <constant>true</constant>
8453 on more than one machine in your network.</para>
8455 <para>Default: <command>wins support = no</command></para>
8456 </listitem>
8457 </varlistentry>
8461 <varlistentry>
8462 <term><anchor id="WORKGROUP">workgroup (G)</term>
8463 <listitem><para>This controls what workgroup your server will
8464 appear to be in when queried by clients. Note that this parameter
8465 also controls the Domain name used with the <link
8466 linkend="SECURITYEQUALSDOMAIN"><command>security = domain</command></link>
8467 setting.</para>
8469 <para>Default: <emphasis>set at compile time to WORKGROUP</emphasis></para>
8470 <para>Example: <command>workgroup = MYGROUP</command></para>
8471 </listitem>
8472 </varlistentry>
8477 <varlistentry>
8478 <term><anchor id="WRITABLE">writable (S)</term>
8479 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="WRITEABLE"><parameter>
8480 writeable</parameter></link> for people who can't spell :-).</para>
8481 </listitem>
8482 </varlistentry>
8486 <varlistentry>
8487 <term><anchor id="WRITECACHESIZE">write cache size (S)</term>
8488 <listitem><para>If this integer parameter is set to non-zero value,
8489 Samba will create an in-memory cache for each oplocked file
8490 (it does <emphasis>not</emphasis> do this for
8491 non-oplocked files). All writes that the client does not request
8492 to be flushed directly to disk will be stored in this cache if possible.
8493 The cache is flushed onto disk when a write comes in whose offset
8494 would not fit into the cache or when the file is closed by the client.
8495 Reads for the file are also served from this cache if the data is stored
8496 within it.</para>
8498 <para>This cache allows Samba to batch client writes into a more
8499 efficient write size for RAID disks (i.e. writes may be tuned to
8500 be the RAID stripe size) and can improve performance on systems
8501 where the disk subsystem is a bottleneck but there is free
8502 memory for userspace programs.</para>
8504 <para>The integer parameter specifies the size of this cache
8505 (per oplocked file) in bytes.</para>
8507 <para>Default: <command>write cache size = 0</command></para>
8508 <para>Example: <command>write cache size = 262144</command></para>
8510 <para>for a 256k cache size per file.</para>
8511 </listitem>
8512 </varlistentry>
8518 <varlistentry>
8519 <term><anchor id="WRITELIST">write list (S)</term>
8520 <listitem><para>This is a list of users that are given read-write
8521 access to a service. If the connecting user is in this list then
8522 they will be given write access, no matter what the <link
8523 linkend="WRITEABLE"><parameter>writeable</parameter></link>
8524 option is set to. The list can include group names using the
8525 @group syntax.</para>
8527 <para>Note that if a user is in both the read list and the
8528 write list then they will be given write access.</para>
8530 <para>See also the <link linkend="READLIST"><parameter>read list
8531 </parameter></link> option.</para>
8533 <para>Default: <command>write list = &lt;empty string&gt;
8534 </command></para>
8536 <para>Example: <command>write list = admin, root, @staff
8537 </command></para>
8538 </listitem>
8539 </varlistentry>
8545 <varlistentry>
8546 <term><anchor id="WRITEOK">write ok (S)</term>
8547 <listitem><para>Synonym for <link linkend="WRITEABLE"><parameter>
8548 writeable</parameter></link>.</para>
8549 </listitem>
8550 </varlistentry>
8554 <varlistentry>
8555 <term><anchor id="WRITERAW">write raw (G)</term>
8556 <listitem><para>This parameter controls whether or not the server
8557 will support raw write SMB's when transferring data from clients.
8558 You should never need to change this parameter.</para>
8560 <para>Default: <command>write raw = yes</command></para>
8561 </listitem>
8562 </varlistentry>
8566 <varlistentry>
8567 <term><anchor id="WRITEABLE">writeable (S)</term>
8568 <listitem><para>An inverted synonym is <link linkend="READONLY">
8569 <parameter>read only</parameter></link>.</para>
8571 <para>If this parameter is <constant>no</constant>, then users
8572 of a service may not create or modify files in the service's
8573 directory.</para>
8575 <para>Note that a printable service (<command>printable = yes</command>)
8576 will <emphasis>ALWAYS</emphasis> allow writing to the directory
8577 (user privileges permitting), but only via spooling operations.</para>
8579 <para>Default: <command>writeable = no</command></para>
8580 </listitem>
8581 </varlistentry>
8584 </variablelist>
8586 </refsect1>
8588 <refsect1>
8589 <title>WARNINGS</title>
8591 <para>Although the configuration file permits service names
8592 to contain spaces, your client software may not. Spaces will
8593 be ignored in comparisons anyway, so it shouldn't be a
8594 problem - but be aware of the possibility.</para>
8596 <para>On a similar note, many clients - especially DOS clients -
8597 limit service names to eight characters. <ulink url="smbd.8.html">smbd(8)
8598 </ulink> has no such limitation, but attempts to connect from such
8599 clients will fail if they truncate the service names. For this reason
8600 you should probably keep your service names down to eight characters
8601 in length.</para>
8603 <para>Use of the [homes] and [printers] special sections make life
8604 for an administrator easy, but the various combinations of default
8605 attributes can be tricky. Take extreme care when designing these
8606 sections. In particular, ensure that the permissions on spool
8607 directories are correct.</para>
8608 </refsect1>
8610 <refsect1>
8611 <title>VERSION</title>
8613 <para>This man page is correct for version 2.2 of
8614 the Samba suite.</para>
8615 </refsect1>
8617 <refsect1>
8618 <title>SEE ALSO</title>
8619 <para><ulink url="samba.7.html">samba(7)</ulink>,
8620 <ulink url="smbpasswd.8.html"><command>smbpasswd(8)</command></ulink>,
8621 <ulink url="swat.8.html"><command>swat(8)</command></ulink>,
8622 <ulink url="smbd.8.html"><command>smbd(8)</command></ulink>,
8623 <ulink url="nmbd.8.html"><command>nmbd(8)</command></ulink>,
8624 <ulink url="smbclient.1.html"><command>smbclient(1)</command></ulink>,
8625 <ulink url="nmblookup.1.html"><command>nmblookup(1)</command></ulink>,
8626 <ulink url="testparm.1.html"><command>testparm(1)</command></ulink>,
8627 <ulink url="testprns.1.html"><command>testprns(1)</command></ulink>
8628 </para>
8629 </refsect1>
8631 <refsect1>
8632 <title>AUTHOR</title>
8634 <para>The original Samba software and related utilities
8635 were created by Andrew Tridgell. Samba is now developed
8636 by the Samba Team as an Open Source project similar
8637 to the way the Linux kernel is developed.</para>
8639 <para>The original Samba man pages were written by Karl Auer.
8640 The man page sources were converted to YODL format (another
8641 excellent piece of Open Source software, available at
8642 <ulink url="ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/">
8643 ftp://ftp.icce.rug.nl/pub/unix/</ulink>) and updated for the Samba 2.0
8644 release by Jeremy Allison. The conversion to DocBook for
8645 Samba 2.2 was done by Gerald Carter</para>
8646 </refsect1>
8648 </refentry>